* lisp/vc/pcvs.el (cvs-cleanup-collection): Extend meaning of `rm-handled'.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobf63f10566f64eff37053c5367e4d01b9c7c61526
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
45 #include "systime.h"
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
81 #include <unistd.h>
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
133 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
134 #ifdef USE_XIM
135 int use_xim = 1;
136 #else
137 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
138 #endif
142 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
143 start. */
145 static int any_help_event_p;
147 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
148 static Lisp_Object last_window;
150 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 use. */
153 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
155 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
156 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
157 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
158 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
160 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
162 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
164 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
166 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
168 static struct {
169 struct frame *f;
170 int eventtype;
171 } pending_event_wait;
173 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
174 /* The application context for Xt use. */
175 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
176 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
178 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
180 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
181 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
183 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
184 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
185 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
187 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
189 /* Mouse movement.
191 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
192 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
193 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
194 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
196 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
198 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
199 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
200 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
201 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
202 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
203 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
204 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
205 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
206 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 is off. */
209 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
211 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
212 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
213 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
215 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
217 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
218 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
219 an ordinary motion.
221 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
222 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
223 event. */
225 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
227 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
228 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
229 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
230 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
231 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
232 it's somewhat accurate. */
234 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
236 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
238 static Time last_user_time;
240 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
241 events. */
243 static int volatile input_signal_count;
245 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
247 static int x_noop_count;
249 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
251 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
252 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
254 #ifdef USE_GTK
255 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
256 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
258 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
259 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
260 #endif
262 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
263 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
265 enum xembed_info
267 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
270 enum xembed_message
272 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
273 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
274 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
275 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
277 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
281 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
282 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
283 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
284 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
285 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
288 /* Used in x_flush. */
290 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
356 block_input ();
357 if (f == NULL)
359 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
360 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
361 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
362 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
364 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
365 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
366 unblock_input ();
370 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
371 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
372 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
373 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
374 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
375 performance. */
377 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
380 /***********************************************************************
381 Debugging
382 ***********************************************************************/
384 #if 0
386 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
387 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
389 struct record
391 char *locus;
392 int type;
395 struct record event_record[100];
397 int event_record_index;
399 void
400 record_event (char *locus, int type)
402 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
403 event_record_index = 0;
405 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
406 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
407 event_record_index++;
410 #endif /* 0 */
414 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
416 struct x_display_info *
417 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
419 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
421 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
422 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
423 return dpyinfo;
425 return 0;
428 static Window
429 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
431 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
432 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
433 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
435 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
437 Window root;
438 Window *children;
439 unsigned int nchildren;
441 win = wi;
442 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
443 XFree (children);
446 return win;
449 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
451 void
452 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
455 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
456 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
457 double alpha = 1.0;
458 double alpha_min = 1.0;
459 unsigned long opac;
460 Window parent;
462 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
463 alpha = f->alpha[0];
464 else
465 alpha = f->alpha[1];
467 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
468 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
469 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
472 if (alpha < 0.0)
473 return;
474 else if (alpha > 1.0)
475 alpha = 1.0;
476 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
477 alpha = alpha_min;
479 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
481 x_catch_errors (dpy);
483 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
484 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
485 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
486 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
488 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
489 if (parent != None)
490 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
491 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
492 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
494 /* return unless necessary */
496 unsigned char *data;
497 Atom actual;
498 int rc, format;
499 unsigned long n, left;
501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
503 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
504 &data);
506 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
508 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
509 XFree (data);
510 if (value == opac)
512 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 return;
518 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
520 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
525 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
527 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
531 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
533 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
537 /***********************************************************************
538 Starting and ending an update
539 ***********************************************************************/
541 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
542 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
543 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
544 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
545 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
547 static void
548 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
550 /* Nothing to do. */
554 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
555 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
556 position of W. */
558 static void
559 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
562 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
564 updated_window = w;
565 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
567 block_input ();
569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
571 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
572 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
574 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
575 highlighting. */
576 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
580 unblock_input ();
584 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
586 static void
587 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
590 struct face *face;
592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
593 if (face)
594 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
595 face->foreground);
597 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
598 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
601 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
603 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
604 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
606 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
607 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
608 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
610 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
611 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
612 here. */
614 static void
615 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
619 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
621 block_input ();
623 if (cursor_on_p)
624 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
625 output_cursor.vpos,
626 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
628 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
629 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
631 unblock_input ();
634 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
635 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
636 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
643 updated_window = NULL;
647 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
648 update_end. */
650 static void
651 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
653 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
654 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
656 #ifndef XFlush
657 block_input ();
658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
659 unblock_input ();
660 #endif
664 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
665 complete update has been performed. The global variable
666 updated_window is not available here. */
668 static void
669 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
671 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
672 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
676 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
677 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
678 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
679 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
680 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
681 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
683 static void
684 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
686 struct window *w = updated_window;
687 struct frame *f;
688 int width, height;
690 eassert (w);
692 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
693 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
695 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
696 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
697 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
698 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
699 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
700 overhead is very small. */
701 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
702 && desired_row->full_width_p
703 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
704 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
705 width != 0)
706 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
707 height > 0))
709 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
711 block_input ();
712 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
713 0, y, width, height, False);
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
716 y, width, height, False);
717 unblock_input ();
721 static void
722 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
724 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
725 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
726 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
727 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
728 struct face *face = p->face;
730 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
731 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
733 if (!p->overlay_p)
735 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
737 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
738 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
739 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
740 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
741 if (face->stipple)
742 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
743 else
744 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
746 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
747 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
748 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
749 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
750 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
751 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
752 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
755 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
757 if (sb_width > 0)
759 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
760 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
761 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
763 if (bx < 0)
765 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
766 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
767 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
768 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
769 bx = bar_area_x;
770 if (bx >= 0)
772 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
774 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
775 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
776 row->y));
777 ny = row->visible_height;
780 else
782 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
784 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
785 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
787 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
792 #endif
793 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
794 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
796 if (!face->stipple)
797 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
800 if (p->which)
802 char *bits;
803 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
804 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
805 XGCValues gcv;
807 if (p->wd > 8)
808 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
809 else
810 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
812 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
813 by the server. */
814 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
815 (p->cursor_p
816 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
817 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
818 : face->foreground),
819 face->background, depth);
821 if (p->overlay_p)
823 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
824 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
825 bits, p->wd, p->h,
826 1, 0, 1);
827 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
828 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
829 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
830 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
833 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
834 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
835 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
837 if (p->overlay_p)
839 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
840 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
841 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
845 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
850 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
851 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
852 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
853 rarely happens). */
855 static void
856 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
860 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
861 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
863 static void
864 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
869 /***********************************************************************
870 Glyph display
871 ***********************************************************************/
875 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
876 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
878 int);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
883 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
884 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
889 unsigned long *, double, int);
890 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
891 double, int, unsigned long);
892 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
897 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
898 int, int, int);
899 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, int, int, int,
901 XRectangle *);
902 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
903 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
904 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
906 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1008 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1016 static void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1027 static void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1058 else
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1072 static void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1091 XRectangle r;
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1125 else
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1145 static void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1201 int i, x;
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1224 else
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1279 space on the left or right. */
1280 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1282 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1283 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1286 if (s->face->overstrike)
1287 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1290 else
1292 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1293 Lisp_Object glyph;
1294 int y = s->ybase;
1295 int width = 0;
1297 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1299 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1300 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1301 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1302 else
1304 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1306 if (j < i)
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1309 if (s->face->overstrike)
1310 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1311 x += width;
1313 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1314 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1315 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1319 x += wadjust;
1320 j = i + 1;
1321 width = 0;
1324 if (j < i)
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1327 if (s->face->overstrike)
1328 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1334 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1336 static void
1337 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1339 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1340 XChar2b char2b[8];
1341 int x, i, j;
1343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1344 of S to the right of that box line. */
1345 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1346 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1347 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1348 else
1349 x = s->x;
1351 s->char2b = char2b;
1353 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1355 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1356 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1358 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1360 if (len > 0
1361 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1362 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1363 >= 1))
1365 Lisp_Object acronym
1366 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1367 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1368 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1369 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1370 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1371 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1374 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1376 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1377 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1378 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1379 str = buf;
1382 if (str)
1384 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1385 unsigned code;
1387 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1388 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1390 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1391 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1393 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1394 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1395 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1397 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1398 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1399 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1402 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1403 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1404 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1405 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1406 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1407 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1413 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1414 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1415 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1416 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1418 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1420 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1421 cannot be determined. */
1423 static struct frame *
1424 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1426 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1427 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1428 struct frame *f;
1430 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1432 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1433 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1434 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1435 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1436 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1437 widget = XtParent (widget);
1439 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1440 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1441 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1443 f = XFRAME (frame);
1444 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1445 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1446 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1447 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1448 return f;
1450 emacs_abort ();
1453 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1454 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1455 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1456 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1457 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1458 Value is true if successful. */
1460 bool
1461 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1462 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1464 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1465 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1468 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1471 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1474 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1476 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1477 sizeof (Screen *)},
1478 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1479 sizeof (Colormap)}
1483 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1486 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1489 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1491 DPY is the display we are working on.
1493 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1494 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1495 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1496 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1498 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1499 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1501 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1502 we allocated the color or not.
1504 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1506 static Boolean
1507 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1508 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1509 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1511 Screen *screen;
1512 Colormap cmap;
1513 Pixel pixel;
1514 String color_name;
1515 XColor color;
1517 if (*nargs != 2)
1519 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1520 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1521 "XtToolkitError",
1522 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1523 return False;
1526 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1527 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1528 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1530 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1532 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1533 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1535 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1537 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1538 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1540 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1541 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1543 pixel = color.pixel;
1544 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1546 else
1548 String params[1];
1549 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1551 params[0] = color_name;
1552 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1553 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1554 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1555 params, &nparams);
1556 return False;
1559 if (to->addr != NULL)
1561 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1563 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1564 return False;
1567 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1569 else
1571 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1572 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1575 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1576 return True;
1580 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1581 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1582 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1584 APP is the application context in which we work.
1586 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1587 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1588 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1590 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1592 static void
1593 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1594 Cardinal *nargs)
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1627 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1629 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1630 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 int i;
1633 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1634 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1637 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1640 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1644 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1645 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1649 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1650 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1652 void
1653 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1657 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1659 int i;
1660 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1662 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1663 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1664 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1665 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1668 else
1669 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1673 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1674 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1676 void
1677 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1679 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1683 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1684 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1685 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1686 allocated. */
1688 static bool
1689 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1691 bool rc;
1693 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1694 if (rc == 0)
1696 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1697 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1698 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1699 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1700 int nearest, i;
1701 int max_color_delta = 255;
1702 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1703 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1704 int ncells;
1705 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1707 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1709 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1710 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1711 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1712 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1714 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1716 nearest = i;
1717 nearest_delta = delta;
1721 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1722 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1723 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1726 else
1728 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1729 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1730 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1732 XColor *cached_color;
1734 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1735 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1736 (cached_color->red != color->red
1737 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1738 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1740 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1741 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1742 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1746 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1747 if (rc)
1748 register_color (color->pixel);
1749 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1751 return rc;
1755 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1756 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1757 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1758 allocated. */
1760 bool
1761 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1763 gamma_correct (f, color);
1764 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1768 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1769 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1770 get color reference counts right. */
1772 unsigned long
1773 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1775 XColor color;
1777 color.pixel = pixel;
1778 block_input ();
1779 x_query_color (f, &color);
1780 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1781 unblock_input ();
1782 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1783 register_color (pixel);
1784 #endif
1785 return color.pixel;
1789 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1790 boosted.
1792 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1793 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1794 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1795 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1796 use an additional additive factor.
1798 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1799 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1800 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1803 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1804 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1805 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1806 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1807 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1808 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1810 static bool
1811 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1813 XColor color, new;
1814 long bright;
1815 bool success_p;
1817 /* Get RGB color values. */
1818 color.pixel = *pixel;
1819 x_query_color (f, &color);
1821 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1822 eassert (factor >= 0);
1823 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1824 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1825 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1827 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1828 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1830 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1831 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1832 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1833 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1834 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1836 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1837 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1838 /* The additive adjustment. */
1839 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1841 if (factor < 1)
1843 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1844 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1845 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1847 else
1849 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1850 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1851 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1855 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1856 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1857 if (success_p)
1859 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1861 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1862 delta to the RGB values. */
1863 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1865 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1866 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1867 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1868 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1870 else
1871 success_p = 1;
1872 *pixel = new.pixel;
1875 return success_p;
1879 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1880 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1881 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1882 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1883 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1884 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1886 static void
1887 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1889 XGCValues xgcv;
1890 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1892 unsigned long pixel;
1893 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1894 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1895 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1896 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1898 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1899 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1901 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1902 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1903 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1904 if (relief->gc
1905 && relief->allocated_p)
1907 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1908 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1911 /* Allocate new color. */
1912 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1913 pixel = background;
1914 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1915 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1917 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1918 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1921 if (relief->gc == 0)
1923 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1924 mask |= GCStipple;
1925 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1927 else
1928 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1932 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1934 static void
1935 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1937 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1938 unsigned long color;
1940 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1941 color = s->face->box_color;
1942 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1943 && s->img->pixmap
1944 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1945 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1946 else
1948 XGCValues xgcv;
1950 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1951 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1952 color = xgcv.background;
1955 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1956 || color != di->relief_background)
1958 di->relief_background = color;
1959 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1960 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1961 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1962 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1967 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1968 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1969 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1970 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1971 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1972 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1973 when drawing. */
1975 static void
1976 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1977 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1978 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1979 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1981 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1982 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1983 int i;
1984 GC gc;
1986 if (raised_p)
1987 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1988 else
1989 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1990 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1992 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1993 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1994 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1995 corner pixels. */
1997 /* Top. */
1998 if (top_p)
2000 if (width == 1)
2001 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2002 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2003 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2005 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2006 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2007 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2008 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2011 /* Left. */
2012 if (left_p)
2014 if (width == 1)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2017 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2018 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2020 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2021 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2022 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2023 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2026 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2027 if (raised_p)
2028 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2029 else
2030 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2031 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2033 if (width > 1)
2035 /* Outermost top line. */
2036 if (top_p)
2037 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2038 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2039 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2041 /* Outermost left line. */
2042 if (left_p)
2043 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2046 /* Bottom. */
2047 if (bot_p)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2051 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2052 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2053 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2054 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2055 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2058 /* Right. */
2059 if (right_p)
2061 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2062 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2063 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2064 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2065 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2066 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2069 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2073 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2074 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2075 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2076 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2077 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2078 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2080 static void
2081 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2082 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2083 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2085 XGCValues xgcv;
2087 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2088 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2089 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2091 /* Top. */
2092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2093 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2095 /* Left. */
2096 if (left_p)
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2100 /* Bottom. */
2101 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2102 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104 /* Right. */
2105 if (right_p)
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2110 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2114 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2116 static void
2117 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2119 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2120 int left_p, right_p;
2121 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2122 XRectangle clip_rect;
2124 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2125 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2126 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2128 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2129 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2130 ? s->first_glyph
2131 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2133 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2134 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2135 left_x = s->x;
2136 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2137 ? last_x - 1
2138 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2139 top_y = s->y;
2140 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2142 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2143 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2144 && (s->prev == NULL
2145 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2146 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2147 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2148 && (s->next == NULL
2149 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2151 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2153 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2154 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2155 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2156 else
2158 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2159 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2160 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2165 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2167 static void
2168 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2170 int x = s->x;
2171 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2173 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2174 right of that line. */
2175 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2176 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2177 && s->slice.x == 0)
2178 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2180 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2181 by that margin. */
2182 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2183 x += s->img->hmargin;
2184 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2185 y += s->img->vmargin;
2187 if (s->img->pixmap)
2189 if (s->img->mask)
2191 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2192 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2193 trust on the shape extension to be available
2194 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2195 manually. */
2196 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2197 | GCFunction);
2198 XGCValues xgcv;
2199 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2201 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2202 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2203 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2204 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2205 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2207 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2208 image_rect.x = x;
2209 image_rect.y = y;
2210 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2211 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2212 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2213 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2214 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2215 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2217 else
2219 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2221 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2222 image_rect.x = x;
2223 image_rect.y = y;
2224 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2225 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2226 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2227 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2228 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2229 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2231 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2232 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2233 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2234 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2235 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2236 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2237 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2239 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2240 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2241 x - relief, y - relief,
2242 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2243 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2247 else
2248 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2249 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2250 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2254 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2256 static void
2257 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2259 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2260 XRectangle r;
2261 int x = s->x;
2262 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2265 right of that line. */
2266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2268 && s->slice.x == 0)
2269 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2271 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2272 by that margin. */
2273 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2274 x += s->img->hmargin;
2275 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2276 y += s->img->vmargin;
2278 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2279 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2281 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2282 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2284 else
2286 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2287 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2290 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2291 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2292 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2294 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2295 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2296 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2297 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2298 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2299 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2300 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2301 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2303 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2304 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2305 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2306 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2310 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2312 static void
2313 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2315 int x = 0;
2316 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2318 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2319 right of that line. */
2320 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2321 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2322 && s->slice.x == 0)
2323 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2325 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2326 by that margin. */
2327 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2328 x += s->img->hmargin;
2329 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2330 y += s->img->vmargin;
2332 if (s->img->pixmap)
2334 if (s->img->mask)
2336 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2337 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2338 trust on the shape extension to be available
2339 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2340 manually. */
2341 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2342 | GCFunction);
2343 XGCValues xgcv;
2345 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2346 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2347 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2348 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2349 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2351 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2352 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2353 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2354 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2356 else
2358 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2359 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2360 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2362 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2363 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2364 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2365 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2366 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2367 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2368 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2370 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2371 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2372 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2373 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2377 else
2378 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2379 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2380 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2384 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2385 give the rectangle to draw. */
2387 static void
2388 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2390 if (s->stippled_p)
2392 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2393 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2394 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2395 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2397 else
2398 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2402 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2404 s->y
2405 s->x +-------------------------
2406 | s->face->box
2408 | +-------------------------
2409 | | s->img->margin
2411 | | +-------------------
2412 | | | the image
2416 static void
2417 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2419 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2420 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2421 int height;
2422 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2424 height = s->height;
2425 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2426 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2427 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2428 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2430 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2431 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2432 flickering. */
2433 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2434 if (height > s->slice.height
2435 || s->img->hmargin
2436 || s->img->vmargin
2437 || s->img->mask
2438 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2439 || s->width != s->background_width)
2441 if (s->img->mask)
2443 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2444 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2445 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2446 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2447 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2449 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2450 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2451 s->background_width,
2452 s->height, depth);
2454 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2455 pixmap. */
2456 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2458 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2459 if (s->stippled_p)
2461 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2462 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2463 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2464 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2465 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2466 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2467 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2469 else
2471 XGCValues xgcv;
2472 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2473 &xgcv);
2474 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2475 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2476 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2477 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2480 else
2482 int x = s->x;
2483 int y = s->y;
2485 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2486 && s->slice.x == 0)
2487 x += box_line_hwidth;
2489 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2490 y += box_line_vwidth;
2492 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2495 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2498 /* Draw the foreground. */
2499 if (pixmap != None)
2501 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2502 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2503 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2504 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2505 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2507 else
2508 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2510 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2511 if (s->img->relief
2512 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2513 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2514 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2518 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2520 static void
2521 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2523 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2525 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2526 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2528 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2529 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2530 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2531 int x = s->x;
2533 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2535 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2537 if (x < left_x)
2539 background_width -= left_x - x;
2540 x = left_x;
2543 else
2545 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2546 stretch glyph. */
2547 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2549 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2550 background_width -= x - right_x;
2551 x += background_width;
2553 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2554 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2555 x -= width;
2557 /* Draw cursor. */
2558 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2560 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2561 if (width < background_width)
2563 int y = s->y;
2564 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2565 XRectangle r;
2566 GC gc;
2568 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2569 x += width;
2570 else
2571 x = s->x;
2572 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2573 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2575 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2576 gc = s->gc;
2578 else
2579 gc = s->face->gc;
2581 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2582 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2584 if (s->face->stipple)
2586 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2587 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2588 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2589 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2591 else
2593 XGCValues xgcv;
2594 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2595 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2596 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2597 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2601 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2603 int background_width = s->background_width;
2604 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2606 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2607 except for header line and mode line. */
2608 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2610 background_width -= left_x - x;
2611 x = left_x;
2613 if (background_width > 0)
2614 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2617 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2621 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2623 x0 wave_length = 2
2625 y0 * * * * *
2626 |* * * * * * * * *
2627 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2631 static void
2632 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2634 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
2635 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2636 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2638 dx = wave_length;
2639 dy = wave_height - 1;
2640 x0 = s->x;
2641 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
2642 width = s->width;
2643 xmax = x0 + width;
2645 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2647 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2648 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2650 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2651 return;
2653 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2655 /* Draw the waves */
2657 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2658 x2 = x1 + dx;
2659 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2660 y1 = y2 = y0;
2662 if (odd)
2663 y1 += dy;
2664 else
2665 y2 += dy;
2667 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2668 emacs_abort ();
2670 while (x1 <= xmax)
2672 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2673 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2674 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2675 odd = !odd;
2678 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2679 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2683 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2685 static void
2686 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2688 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2690 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2691 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2692 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2693 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2695 int width;
2696 struct glyph_string *next;
2698 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2699 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2700 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2701 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2703 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2704 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2705 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2706 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2707 else
2708 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2709 next->num_clips = 0;
2713 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2714 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2716 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2717 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2718 if (!s->for_overlaps
2719 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2720 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2721 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2724 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2725 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2726 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2727 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2728 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2730 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2731 && !s->clip_tail
2732 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2733 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2734 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2735 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2736 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2737 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2738 else
2739 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2741 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2743 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2744 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2745 break;
2747 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2748 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2749 break;
2751 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2752 if (s->for_overlaps)
2753 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2754 else
2755 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2756 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2757 break;
2759 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2760 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2761 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2762 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2763 else
2764 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2765 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2766 break;
2768 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2769 if (s->for_overlaps)
2770 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2771 else
2772 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2773 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2774 break;
2776 default:
2777 emacs_abort ();
2780 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2782 /* Draw underline. */
2783 if (s->face->underline_p)
2785 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2787 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2788 x_draw_underwave (s);
2789 else
2791 XGCValues xgcv;
2792 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2793 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2794 x_draw_underwave (s);
2795 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2798 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2800 unsigned long thickness, position;
2801 int y;
2803 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
2804 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2806 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2807 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2808 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2810 else
2812 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2813 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2814 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2815 else
2816 thickness = 1;
2817 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2818 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2819 else
2821 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2822 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2823 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2824 specs, and its default is
2826 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2827 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2829 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2830 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2831 position = s->font->underline_position;
2832 else if (s->font)
2833 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2834 else
2835 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2837 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2839 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2840 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2841 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2842 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2843 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2844 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2845 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2846 s->underline_position = position;
2847 y = s->ybase + position;
2848 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2849 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2850 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2851 else
2853 XGCValues xgcv;
2854 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2855 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2856 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2857 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2858 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2862 /* Draw overline. */
2863 if (s->face->overline_p)
2865 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2867 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2868 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2869 s->width, h);
2870 else
2872 XGCValues xgcv;
2873 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2874 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2875 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2876 s->width, h);
2877 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2881 /* Draw strike-through. */
2882 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2884 unsigned long h = 1;
2885 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2887 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2888 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2889 s->width, h);
2890 else
2892 XGCValues xgcv;
2893 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2894 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2895 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2896 s->width, h);
2897 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2901 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2902 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2903 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2905 if (s->prev)
2907 struct glyph_string *prev;
2909 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2910 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2911 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2913 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2914 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2915 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2917 prev->hl = s->hl;
2918 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2919 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2920 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2921 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2922 else
2923 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2924 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2925 prev->hl = save;
2926 prev->num_clips = 0;
2930 if (s->next)
2932 struct glyph_string *next;
2934 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2935 if (next->hl != s->hl
2936 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2938 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2939 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2940 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2942 next->hl = s->hl;
2943 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2944 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2945 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2946 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2947 else
2948 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2949 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2950 next->hl = save;
2951 next->num_clips = 0;
2952 next->clip_head = s->next;
2957 /* Reset clipping. */
2958 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2959 s->num_clips = 0;
2962 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2964 static void
2965 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2967 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2968 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2969 x, y, width, height,
2970 x + shift_by, y);
2973 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2974 for X frames. */
2976 static void
2977 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2979 emacs_abort ();
2983 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2984 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2986 void
2987 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2989 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2990 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2994 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2996 static void
2997 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2999 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3000 longer visible. */
3001 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3002 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3003 output_cursor.x = -1;
3005 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3006 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3007 block_input ();
3009 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3011 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3012 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3013 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3015 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3016 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3017 redisplay, do it here. */
3018 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3019 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3020 #endif
3022 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3024 unblock_input ();
3029 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3031 static void
3032 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3034 block_input ();
3037 #ifdef USE_GTK
3038 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3039 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3040 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3041 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3042 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3043 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3044 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3045 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3046 do { \
3047 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3048 cairo_fill (cr); \
3050 while (0)
3051 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3052 GdkGCValues vals;
3053 GdkGC *gc;
3054 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3055 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3056 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3057 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3058 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3059 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3060 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3061 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3062 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3063 GC gc;
3065 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3066 pixels into background pixels. */
3068 XGCValues values;
3070 values.function = GXxor;
3071 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3072 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3074 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3075 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3077 #endif
3079 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3080 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3081 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3082 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3083 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3084 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3085 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3087 int width;
3089 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3090 edge it is next to. */
3091 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3093 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3094 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3095 break;
3097 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3098 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3099 break;
3101 default:
3102 break;
3105 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3107 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3108 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3110 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3111 flash_left,
3112 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3113 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3114 width, flash_height);
3115 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3116 flash_left,
3117 (height - flash_height
3118 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3119 width, flash_height);
3122 else
3123 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3124 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3125 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3126 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3128 x_flush (f);
3131 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3132 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3134 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3135 available. */
3136 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3138 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3139 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3141 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3142 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3143 break;
3145 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3146 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3148 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3149 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3153 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3154 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3156 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3157 flash_left,
3158 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3159 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3160 width, flash_height);
3161 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3162 flash_left,
3163 (height - flash_height
3164 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3165 width, flash_height);
3167 else
3168 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3169 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3170 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3171 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3173 #ifdef USE_GTK
3174 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3175 cairo_destroy (cr);
3176 #else
3177 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3178 #endif
3179 #undef XFillRectangle
3180 #else
3181 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3182 #endif
3183 x_flush (f);
3187 unblock_input ();
3191 static void
3192 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3194 block_input ();
3195 if (invisible)
3197 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3198 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3199 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3201 else
3202 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3203 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3204 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3205 unblock_input ();
3209 /* Make audible bell. */
3211 static void
3212 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3214 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3216 if (visible_bell)
3217 XTflash (f);
3218 else
3220 block_input ();
3221 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3222 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3223 unblock_input ();
3229 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3230 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3231 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3232 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3234 static void
3235 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3237 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3242 /***********************************************************************
3243 Line Dance
3244 ***********************************************************************/
3246 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3247 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3249 static void
3250 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3252 emacs_abort ();
3256 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3258 static void
3259 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3261 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3262 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3264 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3265 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3266 fringe of W. */
3267 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3269 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3270 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3271 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3272 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3273 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3274 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3275 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3276 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3278 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3280 if (sb_width > 0)
3282 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3283 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3284 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3286 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3288 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3289 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3291 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3292 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3295 #endif
3297 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3298 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3299 bottom_y = y + height;
3301 if (to_y < from_y)
3303 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3304 line at the bottom. */
3305 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3306 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3307 else
3308 height = run->height;
3310 else
3312 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3313 at the bottom. */
3314 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3315 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3316 else
3317 height = run->height;
3320 block_input ();
3322 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3323 updated_window = w;
3324 x_clear_cursor (w);
3326 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3327 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3328 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3329 x, from_y,
3330 width, height,
3331 x, to_y);
3333 unblock_input ();
3338 /***********************************************************************
3339 Exposure Events
3340 ***********************************************************************/
3343 static void
3344 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3346 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3347 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3348 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3349 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3350 block_input ();
3351 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3352 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3353 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3354 because of this (bug#9310). */
3355 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3356 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3357 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3358 x_uncatch_errors ();
3359 unblock_input ();
3360 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3361 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3364 static void
3365 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3367 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3368 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3369 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3370 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3371 block_input ();
3372 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3373 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3374 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3375 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3376 x_uncatch_errors ();
3377 unblock_input ();
3378 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3379 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3382 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3383 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3384 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3385 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3386 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3388 static void
3389 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3391 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3393 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3395 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3396 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3397 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3399 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3400 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3402 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3403 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3404 else
3405 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3408 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3411 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3412 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3413 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3415 static void
3416 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3418 if (type == FocusIn)
3420 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3422 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3423 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3425 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3426 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3427 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3428 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3429 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3430 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3432 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3433 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3437 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3439 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3440 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3441 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3442 #endif
3444 else if (type == FocusOut)
3446 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3448 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3450 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3451 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3454 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3455 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3456 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3457 #endif
3458 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3459 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3463 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3464 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3466 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3468 static void
3469 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3471 struct frame *frame;
3473 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3474 if (! frame)
3475 return;
3477 switch (event->type)
3479 case EnterNotify:
3480 case LeaveNotify:
3482 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3483 int focus_state
3484 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3486 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3487 && event->xcrossing.focus
3488 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3489 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3490 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3491 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3493 break;
3495 case FocusIn:
3496 case FocusOut:
3497 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3498 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3499 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3500 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3501 break;
3503 case ClientMessage:
3504 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3506 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3507 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3508 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3510 break;
3515 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3516 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3518 void
3519 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3521 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3523 #endif
3525 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3526 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3527 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3529 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3530 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3531 the appropriate X display info. */
3533 static void
3534 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3536 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3539 static void
3540 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3542 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3544 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3546 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3547 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3548 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3549 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3550 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3552 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3553 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3556 else
3557 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3559 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3561 if (old_highlight)
3562 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3563 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3564 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3570 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3572 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3573 static void
3574 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3576 int min_code, max_code;
3577 KeySym *syms;
3578 int syms_per_code;
3579 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3581 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3582 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3583 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3584 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3585 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3587 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3589 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3590 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3591 &syms_per_code);
3592 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3594 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3595 Alt keysyms are on. */
3597 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3598 int found_alt_or_meta;
3600 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3602 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3603 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3605 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3607 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3608 if (code == 0)
3609 continue;
3611 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3613 int code_col;
3615 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3617 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3619 switch (sym)
3621 case XK_Meta_L:
3622 case XK_Meta_R:
3623 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3624 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3625 break;
3627 case XK_Alt_L:
3628 case XK_Alt_R:
3629 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3630 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3631 break;
3633 case XK_Hyper_L:
3634 case XK_Hyper_R:
3635 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3636 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3637 code_col = syms_per_code;
3638 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3639 break;
3641 case XK_Super_L:
3642 case XK_Super_R:
3643 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3644 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3645 code_col = syms_per_code;
3646 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3647 break;
3649 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3650 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3651 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3652 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3653 code_col = syms_per_code;
3654 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3655 break;
3663 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3664 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3666 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3667 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3670 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3671 make them just meta, not alt. */
3672 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3674 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3677 XFree (syms);
3678 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3681 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3682 Emacs uses. */
3685 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3687 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3688 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3689 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3690 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3691 Lisp_Object tem;
3693 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3694 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3695 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3696 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3697 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3698 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3699 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3700 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3702 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3703 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3704 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3705 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3706 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3707 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3710 static int
3711 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3713 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3714 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3715 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3716 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3718 Lisp_Object tem;
3720 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3721 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3722 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3723 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3724 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3725 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3726 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3727 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3730 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3731 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3732 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3733 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3734 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3735 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3738 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3740 char *
3741 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3743 char *value;
3745 block_input ();
3746 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3747 unblock_input ();
3749 return value;
3754 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3756 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3758 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3759 the mouse. */
3761 static Lisp_Object
3762 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3764 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3765 otherwise. */
3766 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3767 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3768 result->timestamp = event->time;
3769 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3770 event->state)
3771 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3772 ? up_modifier
3773 : down_modifier));
3775 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3776 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3777 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3778 result->arg = Qnil;
3779 return Qnil;
3783 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3784 The input handler calls this.
3786 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3787 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3788 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3789 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3791 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3792 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3794 static int
3795 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3797 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3798 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3799 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3801 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3802 return 0;
3804 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3806 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3807 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3808 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3809 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3810 return 1;
3814 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3815 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3816 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3817 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3818 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3819 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3821 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3822 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3823 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3824 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3825 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3826 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3827 return 1;
3830 return 0;
3834 /************************************************************************
3835 Mouse Face
3836 ************************************************************************/
3838 static void
3839 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3841 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3842 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3843 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3844 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3845 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3850 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3851 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3853 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3854 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3855 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3856 position on the scroll bar.
3858 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3859 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3860 the mouse is over.
3862 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3863 was at this position.
3865 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3867 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3868 movement. */
3870 static void
3871 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3872 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3873 Time *timestamp)
3875 FRAME_PTR f1;
3877 block_input ();
3879 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3880 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3881 else
3883 Window root;
3884 int root_x, root_y;
3886 Window dummy_window;
3887 int dummy;
3889 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3891 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3892 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3893 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3894 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3895 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3897 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3899 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3900 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3901 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3903 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3904 &root,
3906 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3907 a different screen. */
3908 &dummy_window,
3910 /* The position on that root window. */
3911 &root_x, &root_y,
3913 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3914 &dummy, &dummy,
3916 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3917 we don't care. */
3918 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3920 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3921 containing the pointer. */
3923 Window win, child;
3924 int win_x, win_y;
3925 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3927 win = root;
3929 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3930 structure is changing at the same time this function
3931 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3933 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3935 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3936 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3938 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3939 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3940 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3942 /* From-window, to-window. */
3943 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3945 /* From-position, to-position. */
3946 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3948 /* Child of win. */
3949 &child);
3950 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3952 else
3954 while (1)
3956 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3958 /* From-window, to-window. */
3959 root, win,
3961 /* From-position, to-position. */
3962 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3964 /* Child of win. */
3965 &child);
3967 if (child == None || child == win)
3968 break;
3969 #ifdef USE_GTK
3970 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3971 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3972 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3973 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3974 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3975 break;
3976 #endif
3977 win = child;
3978 parent_x = win_x;
3979 parent_y = win_y;
3982 /* Now we know that:
3983 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3984 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3985 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3986 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3987 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3988 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3989 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3990 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3991 never use them in that case.) */
3993 #ifdef USE_GTK
3994 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3995 want the edit window. */
3996 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3997 #else
3998 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3999 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4000 #endif
4002 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4003 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4004 on the frame. */
4005 if (f1 != NULL
4006 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4007 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4008 f1 = NULL;
4009 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4012 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4013 f1 = 0;
4015 x_uncatch_errors ();
4017 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4018 if (! f1)
4020 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4022 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4024 if (bar)
4026 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4027 win_x = parent_x;
4028 win_y = parent_y;
4032 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4033 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4035 if (f1)
4037 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4038 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4039 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4040 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4041 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4042 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4043 the frame are divided into. */
4045 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4046 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4048 *bar_window = Qnil;
4049 *part = 0;
4050 *fp = f1;
4051 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4052 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4053 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4058 unblock_input ();
4063 /***********************************************************************
4064 Scroll bars
4065 ***********************************************************************/
4067 /* Scroll bar support. */
4069 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4070 manages it.
4071 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4072 bits. */
4074 static struct scroll_bar *
4075 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4077 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4079 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4080 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4081 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4083 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4085 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4087 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4088 continue;
4090 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4091 right window ID. */
4092 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4093 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4094 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4095 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4096 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4097 condemned = Qnil,
4098 ! NILP (bar));
4099 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4100 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4101 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4102 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4105 return NULL;
4109 #if defined USE_LUCID
4111 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4112 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4114 static Widget
4115 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4117 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4119 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4120 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4122 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4124 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4125 return menu_bar;
4127 return NULL;
4130 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4133 /************************************************************************
4134 Toolkit scroll bars
4135 ************************************************************************/
4137 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4139 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4140 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4141 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4142 struct scroll_bar *);
4143 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4144 int, int, int);
4147 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4148 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4150 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4152 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4154 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4156 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4157 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4159 #ifndef USE_GTK
4160 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4162 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4164 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4166 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4167 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4168 to avoid jerkiness. */
4170 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4172 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4173 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4174 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4175 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4177 static void
4178 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4179 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4181 int scroll_bar_p;
4182 const char *end_action;
4184 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4185 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4186 end_action = "Release";
4187 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4188 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4189 end_action = "EndScroll";
4190 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4192 if (scroll_bar_p
4193 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4194 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4196 struct window *w;
4198 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4199 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4200 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4202 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4204 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4205 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4206 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4208 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4209 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4211 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4212 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4215 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4217 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4218 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4220 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4221 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4224 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4225 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4226 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4227 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4229 static void
4230 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4232 XEvent event;
4233 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4234 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4235 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4236 ptrdiff_t i;
4238 block_input ();
4240 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4241 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4242 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4243 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4244 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4245 ev->format = 32;
4247 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4248 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4249 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4250 into that array in the event. */
4251 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4252 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4253 break;
4255 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4257 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4258 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4259 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4260 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4261 scroll_bar_windows =
4262 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4263 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4264 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4265 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4268 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4269 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4270 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4271 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4272 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4273 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4275 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4276 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4277 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4278 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4279 #endif
4281 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4282 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4283 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4284 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4285 unblock_input ();
4289 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4290 in *IEVENT. */
4292 static void
4293 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4295 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4296 Lisp_Object window;
4297 struct window *w;
4299 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4300 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4302 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4304 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4305 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4306 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4307 #ifdef USE_GTK
4308 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4309 #else
4310 ievent->timestamp =
4311 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4312 #endif
4313 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4314 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4315 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4316 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4317 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4321 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4323 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4325 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4328 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4329 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4330 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4332 static void
4333 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4335 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4336 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4337 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4339 switch (cs->reason)
4341 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4342 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4343 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4344 break;
4346 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4347 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4348 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4349 break;
4351 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4354 break;
4356 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4357 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4358 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4359 break;
4361 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4362 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4363 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4364 break;
4366 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4367 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4368 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4369 break;
4371 case XmCR_DRAG:
4373 int slider_size;
4375 /* Get the slider size. */
4376 block_input ();
4377 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4378 unblock_input ();
4380 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4381 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4382 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4383 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4385 break;
4387 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4388 break;
4391 if (part >= 0)
4393 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4394 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4395 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4399 #elif defined USE_GTK
4401 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4402 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4404 static gboolean
4405 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4406 GtkScrollType scroll,
4407 gdouble value,
4408 gpointer user_data)
4410 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4411 gdouble position;
4412 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4413 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4414 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4416 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4417 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4420 switch (scroll)
4422 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4423 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4424 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4425 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4427 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4428 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4429 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4430 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4431 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4433 break;
4434 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4435 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4436 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4437 break;
4438 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4439 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4440 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4441 break;
4442 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4443 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4444 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4445 break;
4446 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4447 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4448 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4449 break;
4452 if (part >= 0)
4454 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4455 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4456 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4459 return FALSE;
4462 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4464 static gboolean
4465 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4466 GdkEventButton *event,
4467 gpointer user_data)
4469 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4470 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4471 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4473 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4474 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4475 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4478 return FALSE;
4482 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4484 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4485 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4486 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4487 the thumb is. */
4489 static void
4490 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4492 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4493 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4494 float shown;
4495 int whole, portion, height;
4496 int part;
4498 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4499 block_input ();
4500 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4501 unblock_input ();
4503 whole = 10000000;
4504 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4506 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4507 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4508 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4509 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4510 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4511 bottom). */
4512 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4513 else
4514 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4516 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4517 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4518 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4519 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4523 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4524 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4525 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4526 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4527 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4528 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4529 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4531 static void
4532 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4534 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4535 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4536 int position = (long) call_data;
4537 Dimension height;
4538 int part;
4540 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4541 block_input ();
4542 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4543 unblock_input ();
4545 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4546 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4548 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4549 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4550 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4551 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4552 else
4553 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4555 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4556 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4557 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4558 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4561 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4563 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4565 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4566 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4568 #ifdef USE_GTK
4569 static void
4570 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4572 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4574 block_input ();
4575 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4576 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4577 scroll_bar_name);
4578 unblock_input ();
4581 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4583 static void
4584 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4586 Window xwindow;
4587 Widget widget;
4588 Arg av[20];
4589 int ac = 0;
4590 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4591 unsigned long pixel;
4593 block_input ();
4595 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4596 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4597 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4598 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4599 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4600 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4601 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4602 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4603 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4605 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4606 if (pixel != -1)
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4609 ++ac;
4612 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4613 if (pixel != -1)
4615 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4616 ++ac;
4619 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4620 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4622 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4623 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4624 (XtPointer) bar);
4625 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4626 (XtPointer) bar);
4627 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4628 (XtPointer) bar);
4629 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4630 (XtPointer) bar);
4631 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4632 (XtPointer) bar);
4633 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4634 (XtPointer) bar);
4635 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4636 (XtPointer) bar);
4638 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4639 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4641 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4642 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4643 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4644 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4646 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4648 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4649 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4650 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4651 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4652 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4653 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4654 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4655 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4657 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4658 if (pixel != -1)
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4661 ++ac;
4664 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4665 if (pixel != -1)
4667 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4668 ++ac;
4671 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4673 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4674 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4676 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4677 if (pixel != -1)
4679 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4680 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4681 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4682 pixel = -1;
4683 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4686 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4688 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4689 if (pixel != -1)
4691 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4692 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4693 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4694 pixel = -1;
4695 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4699 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4700 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4701 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4702 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4703 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4704 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4705 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4706 colors itself. */
4708 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4709 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4710 ++ac;
4712 else
4713 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4714 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4715 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4717 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4718 the shadows. */
4719 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4720 ++ac;
4722 /* Specify the colors. */
4723 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4724 if (pixel != -1)
4726 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4727 ++ac;
4729 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4730 if (pixel != -1)
4732 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4733 ++ac;
4736 #endif
4738 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4739 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4742 char const *initial = "";
4743 char const *val = initial;
4744 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4745 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4746 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4747 #endif
4748 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4749 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4750 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4751 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4752 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4753 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4757 /* Define callbacks. */
4758 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4759 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4760 (XtPointer) bar);
4762 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4763 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4765 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4767 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4768 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4769 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4770 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4772 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4773 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4774 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4775 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4777 unblock_input ();
4779 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4782 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4783 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4785 #ifdef USE_GTK
4786 static void
4787 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4789 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4792 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4793 static void
4794 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4795 int whole)
4797 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4798 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4799 float top, shown;
4801 block_input ();
4803 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4805 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4806 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4807 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4808 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4809 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4810 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4811 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4812 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4813 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4814 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4815 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4816 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4817 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4818 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4819 whole += portion;
4821 if (whole <= 0)
4822 top = 0, shown = 1;
4823 else
4825 top = (float) position / whole;
4826 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4829 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4831 int size, value;
4833 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4834 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4835 value. */
4836 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
4838 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4839 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4840 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4842 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4844 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4846 if (whole == 0)
4847 top = 0, shown = 1;
4848 else
4850 top = (float) position / whole;
4851 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4855 float old_top, old_shown;
4856 Dimension height;
4857 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4858 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4859 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4860 XtNheight, &height,
4861 NULL);
4863 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4864 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4865 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4866 else
4867 top = old_top;
4868 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4869 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4871 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4872 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4873 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4874 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4876 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4877 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4878 else
4880 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4881 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4882 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4884 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4888 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4890 unblock_input ();
4892 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4894 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4898 /************************************************************************
4899 Scroll bars, general
4900 ************************************************************************/
4902 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4903 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4904 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4905 scroll bar. */
4907 static struct scroll_bar *
4908 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4910 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4911 struct scroll_bar *bar
4912 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4913 Lisp_Object barobj;
4915 block_input ();
4917 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4918 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4919 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4921 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4922 unsigned long mask;
4923 Window window;
4925 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4926 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4927 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4929 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4930 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4931 | ExposureMask);
4932 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4934 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4936 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4937 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4938 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4939 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4940 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4941 left, top, width,
4942 window_box_height (w), False);
4944 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4945 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4946 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4947 top,
4948 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4949 height,
4950 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4952 CopyFromParent,
4953 CopyFromParent,
4954 CopyFromParent,
4955 /* Attributes. */
4956 mask, &a);
4957 bar->x_window = window;
4959 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4961 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4962 bar->top = top;
4963 bar->left = left;
4964 bar->width = width;
4965 bar->height = height;
4966 bar->start = 0;
4967 bar->end = 0;
4968 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4969 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4971 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4972 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4973 bar->prev = Qnil;
4974 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4975 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4976 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4977 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4979 /* Map the window/widget. */
4980 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4982 #ifdef USE_GTK
4983 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4984 bar->x_window,
4985 top,
4986 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4987 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4988 max (height, 1));
4989 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4990 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4991 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4992 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4993 top,
4994 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4995 max (height, 1), 0);
4996 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4997 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4999 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5000 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5001 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5003 unblock_input ();
5004 return bar;
5008 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5010 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5012 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5013 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5014 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5015 events.)
5017 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5018 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5019 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5020 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5021 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5023 static void
5024 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5026 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5027 Window w = bar->x_window;
5028 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5029 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5031 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5032 if (! rebuild
5033 && start == bar->start
5034 && end == bar->end)
5035 return;
5037 block_input ();
5040 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5041 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5042 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5044 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5045 the distance between start and end. */
5047 int length = end - start;
5049 if (start < 0)
5050 start = 0;
5051 else if (start > top_range)
5052 start = top_range;
5053 end = start + length;
5055 if (end < start)
5056 end = start;
5057 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5058 end = top_range;
5061 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5062 bar->start = start;
5063 bar->end = end;
5065 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5066 if (end > top_range)
5067 end = top_range;
5069 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5070 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5071 that many pixels tall. */
5072 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5074 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5075 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5076 if (0 < start)
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5078 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5079 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5080 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5081 inside_width, start,
5082 False);
5084 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5085 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5086 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5087 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5089 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5090 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5091 /* x, y, width, height */
5092 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5093 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5094 inside_width, end - start);
5096 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5097 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5098 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5099 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5101 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5102 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5103 if (end < inside_height)
5104 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5105 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5106 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5107 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5108 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5109 False);
5113 unblock_input ();
5116 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5118 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5119 nil. */
5121 static void
5122 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5124 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5125 block_input ();
5127 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5128 #ifdef USE_GTK
5129 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5130 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5131 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5132 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5133 #else
5134 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5135 #endif
5137 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5138 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5140 unblock_input ();
5144 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5145 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5146 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5147 create one. */
5149 static void
5150 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5152 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5153 Lisp_Object barobj;
5154 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5155 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5156 int window_y, window_height;
5157 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5158 int fringe_extended_p;
5159 #endif
5161 /* Get window dimensions. */
5162 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5163 top = window_y;
5164 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5165 height = window_height;
5167 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5168 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5170 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5171 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5172 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5173 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5174 else
5175 sb_width = width;
5177 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5178 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5179 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5180 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5181 else
5182 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5183 #else
5184 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5185 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5186 else
5187 sb_left = left;
5188 #endif
5190 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5191 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5192 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5193 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5194 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5195 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5196 else
5197 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5198 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5199 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5200 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5201 #endif
5203 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5204 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5206 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5208 block_input ();
5209 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5210 if (fringe_extended_p)
5211 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5212 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5213 else
5214 #endif
5215 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5216 left, top, width, height, False);
5217 unblock_input ();
5220 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5222 else
5224 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5225 unsigned int mask = 0;
5227 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5229 block_input ();
5231 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5232 mask |= CWX;
5233 if (top != bar->top)
5234 mask |= CWY;
5235 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5236 mask |= CWWidth;
5237 if (height != bar->height)
5238 mask |= CWHeight;
5240 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5242 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5243 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5245 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5246 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5247 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5249 if (fringe_extended_p)
5250 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5251 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5252 else
5253 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5254 left, top, width, height, False);
5256 #ifdef USE_GTK
5257 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5258 bar->x_window,
5259 top,
5260 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5261 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5262 max (height, 1));
5263 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5264 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5265 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5266 top,
5267 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5268 max (height, 1), 0);
5269 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5271 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5273 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5274 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5275 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5277 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5278 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5279 height, False);
5280 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5281 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5282 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5283 height, False);
5286 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5287 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5288 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5289 example. */
5291 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5292 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5293 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5295 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5296 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5297 left + area_width - rest, top,
5298 rest, height, False);
5299 else
5300 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5301 left, top, rest, height, False);
5305 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5306 if (mask)
5308 XWindowChanges wc;
5310 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5311 wc.y = top;
5312 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5313 wc.height = height;
5314 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5315 mask, &wc);
5318 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5320 /* Remember new settings. */
5321 bar->left = sb_left;
5322 bar->top = top;
5323 bar->width = sb_width;
5324 bar->height = height;
5326 unblock_input ();
5329 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5330 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5332 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5333 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5334 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5335 dragged. */
5336 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5338 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5340 if (whole == 0)
5341 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5342 else
5344 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5345 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5346 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5349 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5351 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5352 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5356 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5357 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5358 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5359 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5360 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5361 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5362 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5364 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5365 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5366 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5368 static void
5369 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5371 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5372 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5374 Lisp_Object bar;
5375 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5376 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5377 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5378 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5379 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5380 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5381 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5386 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5387 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5389 static void
5390 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5392 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5393 struct frame *f;
5394 Lisp_Object barobj;
5396 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5397 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5398 emacs_abort ();
5400 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5402 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5403 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5404 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5406 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5407 the lists. */
5408 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5409 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5410 return;
5411 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5412 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5413 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5414 else
5415 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5416 one or the other! */
5417 emacs_abort ();
5419 else
5420 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5422 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5423 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5425 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5426 bar->prev = Qnil;
5427 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5428 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5429 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5430 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5433 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5434 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5436 static void
5437 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5439 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5441 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5443 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5444 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5445 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5447 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5449 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5451 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5453 next = b->next;
5454 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5457 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5458 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5462 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5463 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5464 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5466 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5467 mark bits. */
5469 static void
5470 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5472 Window w = bar->x_window;
5473 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5474 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5475 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5477 block_input ();
5479 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5481 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5482 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5483 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5484 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5486 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5487 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5489 /* x, y, width, height */
5490 0, 0,
5491 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5492 bar->height - 1);
5494 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5495 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5496 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5497 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5499 unblock_input ();
5502 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5504 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5505 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5507 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5508 mark bits. */
5511 static void
5512 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5514 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5515 emacs_abort ();
5517 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5518 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5519 emacs_event->modifiers
5520 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5521 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5522 event->xbutton.state)
5523 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5524 ? up_modifier
5525 : down_modifier));
5526 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5527 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5528 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5530 int top_range
5531 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5532 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5534 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5535 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5537 if (y < bar->start)
5538 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5539 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5540 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5541 else
5542 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5544 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5545 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5546 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5547 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5549 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5550 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5552 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5553 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5555 #endif
5557 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5558 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5562 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5564 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5566 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5567 mark bits. */
5569 static void
5570 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5572 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5574 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5576 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5577 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5579 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5580 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5582 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5583 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5585 if (new_start != bar->start)
5587 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5589 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5594 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5596 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5597 on the scroll bar. */
5599 static void
5600 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5601 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5602 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5604 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5605 Window w = bar->x_window;
5606 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5607 int win_x, win_y;
5608 Window dummy_window;
5609 int dummy_coord;
5610 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5612 block_input ();
5614 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5615 report that. */
5616 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5618 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5619 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5620 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5622 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5623 &win_x, &win_y,
5625 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5626 &dummy_mask))
5628 else
5630 int top_range
5631 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5633 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5635 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5636 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5638 if (win_y < 0)
5639 win_y = 0;
5640 if (win_y > top_range)
5641 win_y = top_range;
5643 *fp = f;
5644 *bar_window = bar->window;
5646 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5647 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5648 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5649 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5650 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5651 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5652 else
5653 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5655 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5656 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5658 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5659 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5662 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5664 unblock_input ();
5668 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5669 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5670 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5671 redraw them. */
5673 static void
5674 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5676 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5677 Lisp_Object bar;
5679 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5680 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5681 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5682 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5683 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5684 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5685 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5686 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5687 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5688 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5692 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5694 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5695 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5696 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5697 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5699 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5700 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5702 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5704 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5705 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5707 static int temp_index;
5708 static short temp_buffer[100];
5710 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5711 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5712 temp_index = 0; \
5713 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5715 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5716 on a particular display. */
5718 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5720 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5721 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5722 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5723 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5725 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5727 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5728 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5729 do \
5731 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5732 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5733 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5734 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5735 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5736 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5738 while (0)
5739 #endif
5741 enum
5743 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5744 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5745 X_EVENT_DROP
5748 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5749 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5750 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5752 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5753 this event further.
5754 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5756 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5757 static int
5758 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5760 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5761 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5762 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5763 was created. */
5765 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5766 event->xclient.window);
5768 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5770 #endif
5772 #ifdef USE_GTK
5773 static int current_count;
5774 static int current_finish;
5775 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5777 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5778 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5779 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5780 static GdkFilterReturn
5781 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5783 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5785 block_input ();
5786 if (current_count >= 0)
5788 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5790 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5792 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5793 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5794 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5795 so we do it here. */
5796 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5797 && dpyinfo
5798 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5800 unblock_input ();
5801 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5803 #endif
5805 if (! dpyinfo)
5806 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5807 else
5808 current_count +=
5809 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5810 current_hold_quit);
5812 else
5813 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5815 unblock_input ();
5817 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5818 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5820 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5822 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5825 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5826 enum xembed_message,
5827 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5829 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5831 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5832 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5833 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5835 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5837 static int
5838 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5839 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5841 union {
5842 struct input_event ie;
5843 struct selection_input_event sie;
5844 } inev;
5845 int count = 0;
5846 int do_help = 0;
5847 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5848 struct frame *f = NULL;
5849 struct coding_system coding;
5850 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5851 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5852 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5854 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5856 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5857 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5858 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5860 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5861 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5863 switch (event.type)
5865 case ClientMessage:
5867 if (event.xclient.message_type
5868 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5869 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5871 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5872 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5874 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5875 could be the shell widget window
5876 if the frame has no title bar. */
5877 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5878 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5879 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5880 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5881 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5882 #endif
5883 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5884 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5885 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5886 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5887 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5888 needed.
5890 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5891 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5892 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5893 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5894 Emacs. */
5896 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5897 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5898 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5899 if (f)
5901 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5902 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5903 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5904 x_catch_errors (d);
5905 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5906 /* The ICCCM says this is
5907 the only valid choice. */
5908 RevertToParent,
5909 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5910 /* This is needed to detect the error
5911 if there is an error. */
5912 XSync (d, False);
5913 x_uncatch_errors ();
5915 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5916 #endif /* 0 */
5917 goto done;
5920 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5921 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5923 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5924 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5925 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5926 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5927 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5928 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5929 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5930 session manager and one for this. */
5931 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5932 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5933 #endif
5935 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5936 event.xclient.window);
5937 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5938 for a single Emacs process. */
5939 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5940 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5941 event.xclient.window,
5942 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5943 else if (f)
5944 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5945 event.xclient.window,
5946 0, 0);
5948 goto done;
5951 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5952 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5954 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5955 event.xclient.window);
5956 if (!f)
5957 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5959 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5960 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5961 goto done;
5964 goto done;
5967 if (event.xclient.message_type
5968 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5970 goto done;
5973 if (event.xclient.message_type
5974 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5976 int new_x, new_y;
5977 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5979 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5980 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5982 if (f)
5984 f->left_pos = new_x;
5985 f->top_pos = new_y;
5987 goto done;
5990 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5991 if (event.xclient.message_type
5992 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5994 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5995 if (f)
5996 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5997 &event, NULL);
5998 goto done;
6000 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6002 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6003 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6004 || (event.xclient.message_type
6005 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6007 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6008 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6009 currently never do because we are interested in
6010 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6011 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6012 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6013 if (!f)
6014 goto OTHER;
6015 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6016 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6017 goto done;
6020 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6021 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6022 we construct an input_event. */
6023 if (event.xclient.message_type
6024 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6026 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6027 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6028 goto done;
6030 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6032 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6033 if (event.xclient.message_type
6034 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6036 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6037 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6038 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6040 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6041 goto done;
6044 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6046 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6047 if (!f)
6048 goto OTHER;
6049 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6050 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6052 break;
6054 case SelectionNotify:
6055 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6056 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6057 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6058 goto OTHER;
6059 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6060 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6061 break;
6063 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6064 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6065 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6066 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6067 goto OTHER;
6068 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6070 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6072 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6073 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6074 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6075 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6077 break;
6079 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6080 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6081 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6082 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6083 goto OTHER;
6084 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6086 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6088 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6089 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6090 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6091 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6092 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6093 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6094 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6096 break;
6098 case PropertyNotify:
6099 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6100 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6101 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6102 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6103 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6105 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6106 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6107 treat it as deiconified. */
6108 if (! f->async_iconified)
6109 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6110 f->async_visible = 1;
6111 f->async_iconified = 0;
6112 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6113 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6114 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6115 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6118 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6119 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6120 goto OTHER;
6122 case ReparentNotify:
6123 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6124 if (f)
6126 int x, y;
6127 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6128 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6129 f->left_pos = x;
6130 f->top_pos = y;
6132 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6133 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6134 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6136 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6138 goto OTHER;
6140 case Expose:
6141 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6142 if (f)
6144 #ifdef USE_GTK
6145 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6146 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6147 event.xexpose.window,
6148 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6149 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6150 FALSE);
6151 #endif
6152 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6154 f->async_visible = 1;
6155 f->async_iconified = 0;
6156 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6157 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6159 else
6160 expose_frame (f,
6161 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6162 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6164 else
6166 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6167 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6168 #endif
6169 #if defined USE_LUCID
6170 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6171 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6172 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6174 Widget widget
6175 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6176 if (widget)
6177 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6179 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6181 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6182 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6183 goto OTHER;
6184 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6185 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6186 event.xexpose.window);
6188 if (bar)
6189 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6190 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6191 else
6192 goto OTHER;
6193 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6194 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6196 break;
6198 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6199 source area was obscured or not
6200 available. */
6201 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6202 if (f)
6204 expose_frame (f,
6205 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6206 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6207 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6209 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6210 else
6211 goto OTHER;
6212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6213 break;
6215 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6216 source area was completely
6217 available. */
6218 break;
6220 case UnmapNotify:
6221 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6222 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6224 tip_window = 0;
6225 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6228 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6229 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6230 the frame was deleted. */
6232 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6233 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6234 display that won't ever be seen. */
6235 f->async_visible = 0;
6236 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6237 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6238 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6239 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6240 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6241 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6242 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6244 f->async_iconified = 1;
6246 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6247 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6250 goto OTHER;
6252 case MapNotify:
6253 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6254 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6255 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6256 goto OTHER;
6258 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6259 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6260 frame is visible. */
6261 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6262 if (f)
6264 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6265 the frame's display structures.
6266 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6267 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6268 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6269 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6270 if (! f->async_iconified)
6271 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6273 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6274 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6275 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6276 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6278 f->async_visible = 1;
6279 f->async_iconified = 0;
6280 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6282 if (f->iconified)
6284 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6285 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6287 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6288 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6289 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6290 to update the frame titles
6291 in case this is the second frame. */
6292 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6294 #ifdef USE_GTK
6295 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6296 #endif
6298 goto OTHER;
6300 case KeyPress:
6302 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6303 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6305 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6306 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6307 if (popup_activated ())
6308 goto OTHER;
6309 #endif
6311 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6313 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6314 mouse highlighting. */
6315 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6316 && (f == 0
6317 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6319 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6320 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6323 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6324 if (f == 0)
6326 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6327 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6328 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6329 event.xkey.window);
6330 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6332 widget = XtParent (widget);
6333 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6336 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6338 if (f != 0)
6340 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6341 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6342 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6343 his Emacs hang.
6345 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6346 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6347 status_return even if the input is too long to
6348 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6349 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6350 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6351 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6352 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6353 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6354 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6355 int modifiers;
6356 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6357 Lisp_Object c;
6359 #ifdef USE_GTK
6360 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6361 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6362 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6363 (see above). */
6364 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6365 #endif
6367 event.xkey.state
6368 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6369 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6370 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6372 /* This will have to go some day... */
6374 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6375 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6376 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6377 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6378 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6379 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6380 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6382 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6383 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6384 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6385 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6386 not it is combined with Meta. */
6387 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6388 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6390 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6391 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6393 Status status_return;
6395 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6396 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6397 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6398 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6399 &status_return);
6400 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6402 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6403 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6404 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6405 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6406 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6407 &status_return);
6409 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6410 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6411 break;
6412 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6414 keysym = NoSymbol;
6415 modifiers = 0;
6417 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6418 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6419 emacs_abort ();
6421 else
6422 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6423 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6424 &compose_status);
6425 #else
6426 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6427 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6428 &compose_status);
6429 #endif
6431 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6432 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6433 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6434 break;
6436 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6437 orig_keysym = keysym;
6439 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6440 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6441 inev.ie.modifiers
6442 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6443 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6445 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6446 translations to characters. */
6447 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6448 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6450 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6451 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6452 goto done_keysym;
6455 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6456 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6458 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6459 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6460 else
6461 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6462 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6463 goto done_keysym;
6466 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6467 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6468 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6469 Vx_keysym_table,
6470 Qnil),
6471 NATNUMP (c)))
6473 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6474 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6475 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6476 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6477 goto done_keysym;
6480 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6481 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6482 || keysym == XK_Delete
6483 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6484 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6485 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6486 #endif
6487 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6488 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6489 #ifdef HPUX
6490 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6491 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6492 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6493 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6494 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6495 #endif
6496 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6497 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6498 #endif
6499 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6500 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6501 #endif
6502 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6503 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6504 #endif
6505 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6506 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6507 #endif
6508 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6509 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6510 #endif
6511 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6512 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6513 #endif
6514 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6515 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6516 #endif
6517 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6518 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6519 #endif
6520 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6521 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6522 #endif
6523 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6524 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6525 #endif
6526 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6527 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6528 #endif
6529 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6530 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6534 #endif
6535 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6536 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6537 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6538 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6539 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6540 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6541 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6542 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6543 don't have real modifiers but
6544 should be treated similarly to
6545 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6546 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6547 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6548 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6549 #endif
6552 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6553 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6554 key. */
6555 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6556 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6557 goto done_keysym;
6560 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6561 ptrdiff_t i;
6562 int nchars, len;
6564 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6566 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6567 nchars++;
6568 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6571 if (nchars < nbytes)
6573 /* Decode the input data. */
6575 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6576 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6577 we used just above and the locale. */
6578 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6579 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6580 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6581 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6582 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6583 gives us composition information. */
6584 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6586 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6587 nbytes);
6588 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6589 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6590 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6591 nbytes = coding.produced;
6592 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6593 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6596 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6597 character events. */
6598 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6600 int ch;
6601 if (nchars == nbytes)
6602 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6603 else
6604 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6605 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6606 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6607 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6608 inev.ie.code = ch;
6609 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6612 count += nchars;
6614 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6616 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6617 break;
6620 done_keysym:
6621 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6622 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6623 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6624 client. */
6625 break;
6626 #else
6627 goto OTHER;
6628 #endif
6630 case KeyRelease:
6631 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6632 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6633 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6634 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6635 client. */
6636 break;
6637 #else
6638 goto OTHER;
6639 #endif
6641 case EnterNotify:
6642 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6643 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6645 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6647 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6648 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6650 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6651 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6652 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6653 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6654 #ifdef USE_GTK
6655 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6656 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6657 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6658 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6659 #endif
6660 goto OTHER;
6662 case FocusIn:
6663 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6664 goto OTHER;
6666 case LeaveNotify:
6667 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6668 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6670 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6671 if (f)
6673 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6675 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6676 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6677 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6678 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6681 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6682 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6683 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6684 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6685 if (any_help_event_p)
6686 do_help = -1;
6688 #ifdef USE_GTK
6689 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6690 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6691 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6692 #endif
6693 goto OTHER;
6695 case FocusOut:
6696 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6697 goto OTHER;
6699 case MotionNotify:
6701 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6702 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6703 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6705 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6706 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6707 f = last_mouse_frame;
6708 else
6709 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6711 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6713 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6714 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6717 #ifdef USE_GTK
6718 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6719 f = 0;
6720 #endif
6721 if (f)
6724 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6725 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6726 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6728 Lisp_Object window;
6730 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6731 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6732 0, 0);
6734 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6735 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6736 will be selected only when it is active. */
6737 if (WINDOWP (window)
6738 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6739 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6740 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6741 create event iff we don't leave the
6742 selected frame. */
6743 && (focus_follows_mouse
6744 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6745 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6747 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6748 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6751 last_window=window;
6753 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6754 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6756 else
6758 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6759 struct scroll_bar *bar
6760 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6761 event.xmotion.window);
6763 if (bar)
6764 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6765 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6767 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6768 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6769 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6772 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6773 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6774 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6775 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6776 do_help = 1;
6777 goto OTHER;
6780 case ConfigureNotify:
6781 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6782 #ifdef USE_GTK
6783 if (!f
6784 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6785 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6787 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6788 event.xconfigure.height);
6789 f = 0;
6791 #endif
6792 if (f)
6794 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6795 #ifndef USE_GTK
6796 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6797 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6799 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6800 is called by the code that handles resizing
6801 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6803 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6804 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6805 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6806 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6807 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6808 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6809 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6811 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6812 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6813 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6816 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6817 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6818 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6819 #endif
6821 #ifdef USE_GTK
6822 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6823 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6824 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6825 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6826 #endif
6828 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6831 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6832 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6833 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6834 #endif
6837 goto OTHER;
6839 case ButtonRelease:
6840 case ButtonPress:
6842 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6843 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6844 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6846 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6847 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6848 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6850 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6851 && last_mouse_frame
6852 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6853 f = last_mouse_frame;
6854 else
6855 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6857 #ifdef USE_GTK
6858 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6859 f = 0;
6860 #endif
6861 if (f)
6863 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6864 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6865 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6867 Lisp_Object window;
6868 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6869 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6871 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6872 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6874 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6876 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6877 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6878 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6879 event.xbutton.state));
6883 if (!tool_bar_p)
6884 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6885 if (! popup_activated ())
6886 #endif
6888 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6890 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6891 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6893 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6894 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6896 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6897 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6899 else
6900 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6902 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6903 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6904 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6906 else
6908 struct scroll_bar *bar
6909 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6910 event.xbutton.window);
6912 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6913 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6914 scroll bars. */
6915 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6917 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6918 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6920 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6921 if (bar)
6922 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6923 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6926 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6928 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6929 last_mouse_frame = f;
6931 if (!tool_bar_p)
6932 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6934 else
6935 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6937 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6938 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6939 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6940 if (f != 0)
6941 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6943 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6944 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6945 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6946 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6947 Instead, save it away
6948 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6949 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6950 if (! popup_activated ()
6951 #ifdef USE_GTK
6952 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6953 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6954 #endif
6955 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6956 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6957 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6958 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6959 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6960 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6961 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6962 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6964 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6965 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6966 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6968 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6970 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6971 goto OTHER;
6973 else
6974 goto OTHER;
6975 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6977 break;
6979 case CirculateNotify:
6980 goto OTHER;
6982 case CirculateRequest:
6983 goto OTHER;
6985 case VisibilityNotify:
6986 goto OTHER;
6988 case MappingNotify:
6989 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6990 local cache. */
6991 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6993 case MappingModifier:
6994 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6995 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6996 case MappingKeyboard:
6997 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6999 goto OTHER;
7001 case DestroyNotify:
7002 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7003 break;
7005 default:
7006 OTHER:
7007 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7008 block_input ();
7009 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7010 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7011 unblock_input ();
7012 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7013 break;
7016 done:
7017 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7019 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7020 count++;
7023 if (do_help
7024 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7026 Lisp_Object frame;
7028 if (f)
7029 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7030 else
7031 frame = Qnil;
7033 if (do_help > 0)
7035 any_help_event_p = 1;
7036 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7037 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7039 else
7041 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7042 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7044 count++;
7047 SAFE_FREE ();
7048 *eventptr = event;
7049 return count;
7052 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7054 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7055 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7056 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7058 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7060 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7062 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7063 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7065 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7067 if (dpyinfo)
7068 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7070 return finish;
7072 #endif
7075 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7076 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7078 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7079 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7080 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7081 C chars). */
7083 static int
7084 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7086 int count = 0;
7087 int event_found = 0;
7089 block_input ();
7091 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7092 input_signal_count++;
7094 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7095 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7097 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7098 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7101 #ifndef USE_GTK
7102 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7104 int finish;
7105 XEvent event;
7107 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7109 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7110 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7111 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7112 continue;
7113 #endif
7114 event_found = 1;
7116 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7117 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7119 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7120 goto out;
7123 out:;
7125 #else /* USE_GTK */
7127 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7128 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7129 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7130 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7132 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7133 from all displays. */
7135 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7137 current_count = count;
7138 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7140 gtk_main_iteration ();
7142 count = current_count;
7143 current_count = -1;
7144 current_hold_quit = 0;
7146 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7147 break;
7149 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7151 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7152 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7153 if (! event_found)
7155 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7156 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7157 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7158 x_noop_count++;
7159 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7161 x_noop_count=0;
7163 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7164 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7166 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7168 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7169 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7173 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7174 raise it now. */
7175 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7176 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7178 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7179 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7182 unblock_input ();
7184 return count;
7190 /***********************************************************************
7191 Text Cursor
7192 ***********************************************************************/
7194 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7195 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7197 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7198 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7199 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7201 static void
7202 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7204 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7205 XRectangle clip_rect;
7206 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7208 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7210 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7211 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7212 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7213 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7214 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7216 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7220 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7222 static void
7223 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7225 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7226 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7227 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7228 int x, y, wd, h;
7229 XGCValues xgcv;
7230 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7231 GC gc;
7233 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7234 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7235 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7236 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7237 return;
7239 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7240 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7241 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7243 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7244 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7245 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7246 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7247 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7248 else
7249 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7250 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7251 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7253 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7254 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7255 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7256 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7260 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7262 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7263 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7264 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7265 --gerd. */
7267 static void
7268 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7270 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7271 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7273 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7274 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7275 and mini-buffer. */
7276 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7277 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7278 return;
7280 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7281 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7282 the bar might not be in the window. */
7283 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7285 struct glyph_row *r;
7286 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7287 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7289 else
7291 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7292 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7293 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7294 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7295 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7296 XGCValues xgcv;
7298 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7299 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7300 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7301 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7302 that the glyph is legible. */
7303 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7304 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7305 else
7306 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7307 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7309 if (gc)
7310 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7311 else
7313 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7314 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7317 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7319 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7321 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7323 if (width < 0)
7324 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7325 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7327 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7329 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7330 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7331 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7332 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7334 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7335 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7336 width, row->height);
7338 else
7340 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7342 if (width < 0)
7343 width = row->height;
7345 width = min (row->height, width);
7347 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7348 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7350 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7351 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7352 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7353 row->height - width),
7354 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7357 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7362 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7364 static void
7365 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7367 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7368 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7369 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7370 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7374 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7376 static void
7377 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7379 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7380 x, y, width, height, False);
7381 #ifdef USE_GTK
7382 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7383 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7384 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7385 #endif
7389 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7391 static void
7392 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7394 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7396 if (on_p)
7398 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7399 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7401 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7402 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7403 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7404 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7406 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7407 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7409 else
7411 switch (cursor_type)
7413 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7414 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7415 break;
7417 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7418 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7419 break;
7421 case BAR_CURSOR:
7422 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7423 break;
7425 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7426 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7427 break;
7429 case NO_CURSOR:
7430 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7431 break;
7433 default:
7434 emacs_abort ();
7438 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7439 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7440 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7441 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7442 #endif
7445 #ifndef XFlush
7446 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7447 #endif
7451 /* Icons. */
7453 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7456 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7458 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7460 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7461 return 1;
7463 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7464 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7465 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7466 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7468 if (STRINGP (file))
7470 #ifdef USE_GTK
7471 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7472 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7473 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7474 return 0;
7475 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7476 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7477 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7479 else
7481 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7482 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7484 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7486 #ifdef USE_GTK
7488 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7489 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7490 return 0;
7492 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7494 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7495 if (rc != -1)
7496 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7498 #endif
7500 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7501 if (rc == -1)
7503 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7504 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7505 if (rc == -1)
7506 return 1;
7508 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7509 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7513 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7514 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7515 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7516 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7517 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7519 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7522 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7523 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7525 return 0;
7529 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7530 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7533 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7535 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7536 return 1;
7539 XTextProperty text;
7540 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7541 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7542 text.format = 8;
7543 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7544 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7547 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7548 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7549 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7550 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7552 return 0;
7555 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7557 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7558 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7560 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7561 be called from a signal handler.
7564 struct x_error_message_stack {
7565 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7566 Display *dpy;
7567 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7569 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7571 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7572 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7573 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7575 static void
7576 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7578 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7579 x_error_message->string,
7580 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7583 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7584 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7585 operating on.
7587 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7588 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7589 stored in *x_error_message.
7591 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7592 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7594 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7596 void
7597 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7599 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7601 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7602 XSync (dpy, False);
7604 data->dpy = dpy;
7605 data->string[0] = 0;
7606 data->prev = x_error_message;
7607 x_error_message = data;
7610 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7611 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7613 void
7614 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7616 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7618 block_input ();
7620 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7621 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7622 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7623 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7625 tmp = x_error_message;
7626 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7627 xfree (tmp);
7628 unblock_input ();
7631 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7632 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7633 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7635 void
7636 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7638 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7639 XSync (dpy, False);
7641 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7643 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7644 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7645 x_uncatch_errors ();
7646 error (format, string);
7650 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7651 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7654 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7656 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7657 XSync (dpy, False);
7659 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7662 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7664 void
7665 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7667 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7670 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7671 * idea. --lorentey */
7672 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7674 void
7675 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7677 while (x_error_message)
7678 x_uncatch_errors ();
7680 #endif
7682 #if 0
7683 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7684 x_trace_wire (void)
7686 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7688 #endif /* ! 0 */
7691 /************************************************************************
7692 Handling X errors
7693 ************************************************************************/
7695 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7697 static char *error_msg;
7699 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7700 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7702 static void
7703 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7705 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7706 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7707 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7709 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7710 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7712 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7713 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7715 if (dpyinfo)
7717 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7718 frame on it. */
7719 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7720 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7723 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7724 that are on the dead display. */
7725 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7727 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7728 minibuf_frame
7729 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7730 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7731 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7732 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7733 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7734 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7737 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7738 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7739 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7740 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7741 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7742 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7744 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7745 trying to find a replacement. */
7746 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7747 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7750 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7751 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7752 if (dpyinfo)
7754 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7755 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7756 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7757 #ifdef USE_GTK
7758 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7759 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7760 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7761 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7762 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7763 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7764 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7765 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7766 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7767 error_msg);
7768 emacs_abort ();
7769 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7771 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7772 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7774 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7775 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7776 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7777 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7778 emacs_abort ();
7781 Lisp_Object tmp;
7782 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7783 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7787 if (terminal_list == 0)
7789 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7790 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7791 /* NOTREACHED */
7794 totally_unblock_input ();
7796 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7797 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7799 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7800 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7802 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7803 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7804 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7805 error ("%s", error_msg);
7808 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7809 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7810 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7812 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7813 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7815 static int
7816 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7818 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7819 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7820 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7821 && event->minor_code == 0)
7823 return 0;
7825 #endif
7827 if (x_error_message)
7828 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7829 else
7830 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7831 return 0;
7834 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7835 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7836 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7838 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7840 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7841 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7843 static void NO_INLINE
7844 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7846 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7848 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7849 or colors that are not defined. */
7851 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7852 return;
7854 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7855 original error handler. */
7857 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7858 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7859 buf, event->request_code);
7860 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7864 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7865 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7866 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7868 static int
7869 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7871 char buf[256];
7873 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7874 DisplayString (display));
7875 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7876 return 0;
7879 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7881 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7882 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7883 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7884 FONT-OBJECT. */
7886 Lisp_Object
7887 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7889 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7891 if (fontset < 0)
7892 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7893 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7894 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7895 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7896 do. */
7897 return font_object;
7899 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7900 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7901 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7902 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7904 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7906 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7907 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7909 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7910 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7911 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7913 else
7915 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7916 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7919 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7921 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7922 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7923 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7924 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7925 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7928 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7929 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7930 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7932 block_input ();
7933 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7934 unblock_input ();
7936 #endif
7938 return font_object;
7942 /***********************************************************************
7943 X Input Methods
7944 ***********************************************************************/
7946 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7948 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7950 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7951 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7952 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7954 static void
7955 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7957 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7958 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7960 block_input ();
7962 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7963 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7965 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7966 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7968 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7969 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7973 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7974 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7975 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7976 unblock_input ();
7979 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7981 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7982 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7983 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7984 #endif
7986 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7987 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7989 static void
7990 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7992 XIM xim;
7994 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7995 if (use_xim)
7997 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7998 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7999 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8000 emacs_class);
8001 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8003 if (xim)
8005 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8006 XIMCallback destroy;
8007 #endif
8009 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8010 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8012 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8013 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8014 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8015 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8016 #endif
8020 else
8021 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8022 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8026 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8028 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8029 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8030 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8031 when the callback was registered. */
8033 static void
8034 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8036 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8037 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8039 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8040 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8041 return;
8043 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8045 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8046 as they have no XIC. */
8047 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8049 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8051 block_input ();
8052 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8054 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8056 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8057 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8058 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8060 create_frame_xic (f);
8061 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8062 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8063 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8065 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8066 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8071 unblock_input ();
8075 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8078 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8079 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8080 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8081 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8083 static void
8084 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8086 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8087 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8088 if (use_xim)
8090 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8091 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8092 ptrdiff_t len;
8094 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8095 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8096 len = strlen (resource_name);
8097 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8098 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8099 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8100 resource_name, emacs_class,
8101 xim_instantiate_callback,
8102 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8103 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8104 least, hence the configure test. */
8105 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8106 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8107 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8108 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8110 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8114 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8116 static void
8117 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8119 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8120 if (use_xim)
8122 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8123 if (dpyinfo->display)
8124 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8125 NULL, emacs_class,
8126 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8127 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8128 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8129 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8130 if (dpyinfo->display)
8131 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8132 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8133 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8135 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8138 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8142 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8143 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8145 static void
8146 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8148 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8150 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8151 is already for the top-left corner. */
8152 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8153 return;
8155 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8156 position that fits on the screen. */
8157 if (flags & XNegative)
8158 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8159 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8162 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8164 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8165 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8166 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8168 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8169 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8170 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8171 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8172 is right, though.
8174 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8175 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8177 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8178 #endif
8180 if (flags & YNegative)
8181 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8182 - height + f->top_pos;
8185 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8186 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8187 so the flags should correspond. */
8188 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8191 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8192 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8193 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8194 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8195 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8197 void
8198 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8200 int modified_top, modified_left;
8202 if (change_gravity > 0)
8204 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8205 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8207 f->top_pos = yoff;
8208 f->left_pos = xoff;
8209 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8210 if (xoff < 0)
8211 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8212 if (yoff < 0)
8213 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8214 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8216 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8218 block_input ();
8219 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8221 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8222 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8224 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8226 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8227 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8228 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8229 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8230 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8233 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8234 modified_left, modified_top);
8236 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8237 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8238 ? 1 : 0);
8240 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8241 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8242 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8243 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8244 of the frame.
8246 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8247 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8248 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8250 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8251 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8252 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8253 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8254 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8255 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8257 unblock_input ();
8260 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8261 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8262 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8263 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8264 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8266 static int
8267 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8269 Atom actual_type;
8270 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8271 int i, rc, actual_format;
8272 Window wmcheck_window;
8273 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8274 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8275 long max_len = 65536;
8276 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8277 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8278 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8280 block_input ();
8282 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8283 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8284 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8285 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8286 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8287 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8289 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8291 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8292 x_uncatch_errors ();
8293 unblock_input ();
8294 return 0;
8297 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8298 XFree (tmp_data);
8300 /* Check if window exists. */
8301 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8302 x_sync (f);
8303 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8305 x_uncatch_errors ();
8306 unblock_input ();
8307 return 0;
8310 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8312 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8313 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8314 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8315 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8316 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8317 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8319 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8320 tmp_data = NULL;
8321 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8322 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8323 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8324 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8325 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8327 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8329 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8330 x_uncatch_errors ();
8331 unblock_input ();
8332 return 0;
8335 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8336 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8337 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8340 rc = 0;
8342 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8343 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8345 x_uncatch_errors ();
8346 unblock_input ();
8348 return rc;
8351 static void
8352 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8354 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8356 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8357 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8358 make_number (32),
8359 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8360 Fcons
8361 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8362 Fcons
8363 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8364 value != 0
8365 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8366 : Qnil)));
8369 void
8370 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8372 Lisp_Object frame;
8373 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8375 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8377 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8378 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8381 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8382 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8383 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8385 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8387 static int
8388 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8389 Window window,
8390 int *size_state,
8391 int *sticky)
8393 Atom actual_type;
8394 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8395 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8396 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8397 long max_len = 65536;
8398 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8399 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8400 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8402 *sticky = 0;
8403 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8405 block_input ();
8406 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8407 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8408 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8409 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8410 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8412 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8414 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8415 x_uncatch_errors ();
8416 unblock_input ();
8417 return ! f->iconified;
8420 x_uncatch_errors ();
8422 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8424 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8425 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8427 is_hidden = 1;
8428 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8430 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8432 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8433 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8434 else
8435 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8437 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8439 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8440 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8441 else
8442 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8444 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8445 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8446 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8447 *sticky = 1;
8450 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8451 unblock_input ();
8452 return ! is_hidden;
8455 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8457 static int
8458 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8460 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8461 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8462 int cur, dummy;
8464 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8466 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8467 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8468 if (!have_net_atom)
8469 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8471 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8473 Lisp_Object frame;
8475 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8477 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8478 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8479 are sent at once. */
8480 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8482 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8483 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8484 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8485 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8486 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8487 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8488 break;
8489 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8490 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8491 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8492 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8493 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8494 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8495 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8496 break;
8497 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8498 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8499 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8500 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8501 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8502 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8503 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8504 break;
8505 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8506 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8507 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8508 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8509 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8510 break;
8511 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8512 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8513 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8514 else
8515 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8516 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8519 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8523 return have_net_atom;
8526 static void
8527 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8529 if (f->async_visible)
8531 block_input ();
8532 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8533 x_sync (f);
8534 unblock_input ();
8539 static int
8540 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8542 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8543 Lisp_Object lval;
8544 int sticky = 0;
8545 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8547 lval = Qnil;
8548 switch (value)
8550 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8551 lval = Qfullwidth;
8552 break;
8553 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8554 lval = Qfullheight;
8555 break;
8556 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8557 lval = Qfullboth;
8558 break;
8559 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8560 lval = Qmaximized;
8561 break;
8564 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8565 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8567 return not_hidden;
8570 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8571 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8572 static void
8573 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8575 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8576 return;
8578 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8579 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8581 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8582 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8583 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8585 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8587 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8588 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8590 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8592 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8593 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8594 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8595 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8596 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8597 break;
8598 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8599 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8600 break;
8601 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8602 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8605 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8606 width, height);
8610 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8611 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8612 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8613 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8614 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8615 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8616 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8618 static void
8619 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8621 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8623 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8624 window manager window around the frame. */
8626 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8628 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8630 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8632 int adjusted_left;
8633 int adjusted_top;
8635 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8636 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8637 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8639 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8641 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8642 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8644 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8645 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8647 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8649 else
8650 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8651 frame's position. */
8653 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8657 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8658 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8659 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8660 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8661 of an exact comparison. */
8663 static void
8664 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8666 int count = 0;
8668 while (count++ < 50)
8670 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8672 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8673 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8674 loop. */
8676 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8677 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8679 if (fuzzy)
8681 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8682 pixels. */
8684 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8685 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8686 return;
8688 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8689 return;
8692 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8693 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8695 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8699 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8700 void
8701 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8703 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8705 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8706 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8707 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8709 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8710 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8712 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8713 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8714 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8715 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8717 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8719 pending_signals = 1;
8720 totally_unblock_input ();
8721 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8722 block_input ();
8723 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8725 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8726 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8728 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8729 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8730 break;
8732 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8733 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8734 break; /* Timeout */
8736 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8737 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8741 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8742 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8743 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8744 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8746 static void
8747 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8749 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8751 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8752 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8753 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8755 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8757 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8759 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8760 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8761 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8762 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8764 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8765 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8766 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8767 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8770 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8771 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8772 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8773 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8774 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8776 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8777 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8778 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8779 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8781 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8782 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8783 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8784 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8785 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8787 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8788 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8790 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8791 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8792 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8793 if (f->async_visible)
8794 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8795 else
8797 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8798 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8799 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8800 x_sync (f);
8805 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8806 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8807 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8808 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8810 void
8811 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8813 block_input ();
8815 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8817 int r, c;
8819 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8820 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8821 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8822 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8823 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8824 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8825 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8826 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8827 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8828 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8829 is however. */
8830 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8831 #endif
8832 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8833 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8834 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8835 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8836 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8837 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8838 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8841 #ifdef USE_GTK
8842 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8843 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8844 else
8845 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8846 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8848 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8850 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8852 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8853 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8855 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8856 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8857 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8858 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8859 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8861 unblock_input ();
8864 /* Mouse warping. */
8866 void
8867 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8869 int pix_x, pix_y;
8871 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8872 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8874 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8875 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8877 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8878 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8880 block_input ();
8882 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8883 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8884 unblock_input ();
8887 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8889 void
8890 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8892 block_input ();
8894 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8895 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8896 unblock_input ();
8899 /* Raise frame F. */
8901 void
8902 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8904 block_input ();
8905 if (f->async_visible)
8906 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8908 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8909 unblock_input ();
8912 /* Lower frame F. */
8914 static void
8915 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8917 if (f->async_visible)
8919 block_input ();
8920 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8921 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8922 unblock_input ();
8926 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8928 void
8929 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8931 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8932 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8933 if (f->async_visible)
8934 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8935 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8938 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8940 void
8941 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8943 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8944 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8946 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8947 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8949 Lisp_Object frame;
8950 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8951 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8952 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8953 make_number (32),
8954 Fcons (make_number (1),
8955 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8956 Qnil)));
8960 static void
8961 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8963 if (raise_flag)
8964 x_raise_frame (f);
8965 else
8966 x_lower_frame (f);
8969 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8971 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8973 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8975 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8977 static void
8978 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8980 unsigned long data[2];
8981 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8983 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8984 data[1] = flags;
8986 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8987 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8988 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8990 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8992 static void
8993 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8994 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8996 XEvent event;
8998 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8999 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9000 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9001 event.xclient.format = 32;
9002 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9003 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9004 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9005 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9006 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9008 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9009 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9010 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9013 /* Change of visibility. */
9015 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9016 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9017 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9018 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9019 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9020 finishes with it. */
9022 void
9023 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9025 Lisp_Object type;
9026 int original_top, original_left;
9027 int retry_count = 2;
9029 retry:
9031 block_input ();
9033 type = x_icon_type (f);
9034 if (!NILP (type))
9035 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9037 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9039 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9040 call x_set_offset a second time
9041 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9042 before the window gets really visible. */
9043 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9044 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9045 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9046 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9048 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9050 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9051 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9052 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9053 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9054 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9055 else
9057 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9058 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9060 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9061 #ifdef USE_GTK
9062 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9063 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9064 #else
9065 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9066 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9067 else
9068 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9069 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9070 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9073 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9075 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9076 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9077 so that incoming events are handled. */
9079 Lisp_Object frame;
9080 int count;
9081 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9082 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9083 will set it when they are handled. */
9084 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9086 original_left = f->left_pos;
9087 original_top = f->top_pos;
9089 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9090 unblock_input ();
9092 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9094 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9095 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9096 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9097 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9099 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9100 because the window manager may choose the position
9101 and we don't want to override it. */
9103 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9104 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9105 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9106 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9107 && previously_visible)
9109 Drawable rootw;
9110 int x, y;
9111 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9113 block_input ();
9115 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9116 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9117 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9118 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9119 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9120 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9121 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9122 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9123 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9125 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9126 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9127 original_left, original_top);
9129 unblock_input ();
9132 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9134 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9135 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9136 MapNotify at all.. */
9137 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9138 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9140 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9141 x_sync (f);
9143 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9144 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9145 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9146 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9147 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9148 probably a bug. */
9149 if (input_polling_used ())
9151 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9152 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9153 handler reset it. */
9154 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9155 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9156 poll_for_input_1 ();
9157 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9160 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9161 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9164 /* 2000-09-28: In
9166 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9167 (iconify-frame f)
9168 (raise-frame f))
9170 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9171 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9172 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9173 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9175 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9176 goto retry;
9180 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9182 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9184 void
9185 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9187 Window window;
9189 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9190 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9192 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9193 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9194 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9196 block_input ();
9198 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9199 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9200 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9201 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9202 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9203 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9205 #ifdef USE_GTK
9206 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9207 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9208 else
9209 #else
9210 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9211 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9212 else
9213 #endif
9216 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9217 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9219 unblock_input ();
9220 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9224 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9225 just by the event that we get from the server.
9226 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9227 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9228 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9229 f->visible = 0;
9230 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9231 f->async_visible = 0;
9232 f->async_iconified = 0;
9234 x_sync (f);
9236 unblock_input ();
9239 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9241 void
9242 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9244 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9245 int result;
9246 #endif
9247 Lisp_Object type;
9249 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9250 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9251 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9253 if (f->async_iconified)
9254 return;
9256 block_input ();
9258 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9260 type = x_icon_type (f);
9261 if (!NILP (type))
9262 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9264 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9265 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9267 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9268 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9270 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9271 f->iconified = 1;
9272 f->visible = 1;
9273 f->async_iconified = 1;
9274 f->async_visible = 0;
9275 unblock_input ();
9276 return;
9278 #endif
9280 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9282 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9284 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9285 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9286 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9287 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9288 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9289 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9290 so we have to record it here. */
9291 f->iconified = 1;
9292 f->visible = 1;
9293 f->async_iconified = 1;
9294 f->async_visible = 0;
9295 unblock_input ();
9296 return;
9299 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9300 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9301 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9302 unblock_input ();
9304 if (!result)
9305 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9307 f->async_iconified = 1;
9308 f->async_visible = 0;
9311 block_input ();
9312 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9313 unblock_input ();
9314 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9316 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9317 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9318 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9319 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9320 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9321 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9323 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9324 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9326 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9327 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9329 XEvent msg;
9331 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9332 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9333 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9334 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9335 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9337 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9338 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9339 False,
9340 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9341 &msg))
9343 unblock_input ();
9344 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9348 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9349 IconicState. */
9350 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9352 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9354 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9355 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9358 f->async_iconified = 1;
9359 f->async_visible = 0;
9361 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9362 unblock_input ();
9363 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9367 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9369 void
9370 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9372 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9373 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9374 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9375 Lisp_Object bar;
9376 struct scroll_bar *b;
9377 #endif
9379 block_input ();
9381 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9382 commands to the X server. */
9383 if (dpyinfo->display)
9385 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9386 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9387 face. */
9388 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9389 free_frame_faces (f);
9391 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9392 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9394 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9395 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9396 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9397 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9398 toolkit scroll bars. */
9399 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9401 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9402 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9404 #endif
9406 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9407 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9408 free_frame_xic (f);
9409 #endif
9411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9412 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9414 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9415 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9417 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9418 we are using a toolkit. */
9419 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9420 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9422 free_frame_menubar (f);
9423 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9425 #ifdef USE_GTK
9426 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9427 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9429 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9430 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9431 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9433 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9434 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9435 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9436 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9437 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9438 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9440 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9441 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9442 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9443 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9444 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9445 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9446 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9447 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9448 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9449 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9450 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9451 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9452 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9453 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9454 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9456 x_free_gcs (f);
9457 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9460 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9461 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9462 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9464 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9465 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9466 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9467 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9468 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9469 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9471 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9473 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9474 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9475 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9476 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9477 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9478 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9481 unblock_input ();
9485 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9487 static void
9488 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9490 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9492 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9493 commands to the X server. */
9494 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9495 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9497 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9501 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9503 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9504 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9505 that the window now has.
9506 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9507 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9508 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9510 #ifndef USE_GTK
9511 void
9512 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9514 XSizeHints size_hints;
9515 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9517 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9518 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9520 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9521 return;
9523 #endif
9525 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9526 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9528 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9529 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9531 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9532 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9534 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9535 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9536 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9537 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9538 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9539 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9541 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9543 int base_width, base_height;
9544 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9546 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9547 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9549 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9551 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9552 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9553 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9554 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9555 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9557 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9558 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9559 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9561 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9562 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9563 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9564 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9565 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9568 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9569 if (flags)
9571 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9572 goto no_read;
9576 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9577 long supplied_return;
9578 int value;
9580 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9581 &supplied_return);
9583 if (flags)
9584 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9585 else
9587 if (value == 0)
9588 hints.flags = 0;
9589 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9590 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9591 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9592 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9593 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9594 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9595 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9596 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9600 no_read:
9602 #ifdef PWinGravity
9603 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9604 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9606 if (user_position)
9608 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9609 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9611 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9613 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9615 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9617 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9619 static void
9620 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9622 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9623 Arg al[1];
9625 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9626 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9627 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9628 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9630 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9631 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9633 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9634 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9637 static void
9638 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9640 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9642 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9643 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9644 #endif
9646 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9648 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9649 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9650 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9651 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9653 else
9655 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9656 pixmap. */
9657 return;
9661 #ifdef USE_GTK
9663 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9664 return;
9667 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9670 Arg al[1];
9671 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9672 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9673 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9674 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9677 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9679 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9680 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9682 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9685 void
9686 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9688 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9690 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9691 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9692 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9694 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9698 /***********************************************************************
9699 Fonts
9700 ***********************************************************************/
9702 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9704 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9705 font table. */
9707 static void
9708 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9710 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9711 if (font->driver->check)
9712 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9715 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9718 /***********************************************************************
9719 Initialization
9720 ***********************************************************************/
9722 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9723 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9724 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9725 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9727 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9728 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9729 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9731 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9732 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9733 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9734 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9735 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9736 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9737 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9740 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9742 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9744 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9746 static int x_initialized;
9748 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9749 the screen number from the server number. */
9750 static int
9751 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9753 int seen_colon = 0;
9754 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9755 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9756 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9758 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9759 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9760 length_until_period++;
9762 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9763 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9764 name1 += 4;
9765 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9766 name2 += 4;
9767 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9768 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9769 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9770 name1 += system_name_length;
9771 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9772 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9773 name2 += system_name_length;
9774 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9775 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9776 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9777 name1 += length_until_period;
9778 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9779 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9780 name2 += length_until_period;
9782 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9784 if (*name1 == ':')
9785 seen_colon = 1;
9786 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9787 return 1;
9789 return (seen_colon
9790 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9791 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9794 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9795 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9796 to 5. */
9797 static void
9798 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9800 int nr = 0;
9801 int off = 0;
9803 while (!(mask & 1))
9805 off++;
9806 mask >>= 1;
9809 while (mask & 1)
9811 nr++;
9812 mask >>= 1;
9815 *offset = off;
9816 *bits = nr;
9819 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9820 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9823 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9825 int dpy_ok = 1;
9826 Display *dpy;
9828 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9829 if (dpy)
9830 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9831 else
9832 dpy_ok = 0;
9833 return dpy_ok;
9836 #ifdef USE_GTK
9837 static void
9838 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9839 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9841 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9842 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9844 #endif
9846 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9847 the structure that describes the open display.
9848 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9850 struct x_display_info *
9851 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9853 int connection;
9854 Display *dpy;
9855 struct terminal *terminal;
9856 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9857 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9858 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9859 ptrdiff_t lim;
9861 block_input ();
9863 if (!x_initialized)
9865 x_initialize ();
9866 ++x_initialized;
9869 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9870 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9872 #ifdef USE_GTK
9874 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9875 int argc;
9876 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9877 char **argv2 = argv;
9878 guint id;
9880 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9882 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9884 else
9886 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9887 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9889 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9890 argv[argc] = 0;
9892 argc = 0;
9893 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9895 if (! NILP (display_name))
9897 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9898 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9901 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9902 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9904 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9906 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9907 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9908 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9910 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9911 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9912 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9913 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9915 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9916 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9917 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9919 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9920 fixup_locale ();
9921 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9922 fixup_locale ();
9924 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9926 xg_initialize ();
9928 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9930 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9931 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9933 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9934 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9936 s = build_string (file);
9937 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9939 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9940 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9942 #endif
9944 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9945 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9948 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9949 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9950 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9951 errors with X11R5:
9952 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9953 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9954 So let's not use it until R6. */
9955 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9956 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9957 #endif
9960 int argc = 0;
9961 char *argv[3];
9963 argv[0] = "";
9964 argc = 1;
9965 if (xrm_option)
9967 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9968 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9970 turn_on_atimers (0);
9971 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9972 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9973 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9974 &argc, argv);
9975 turn_on_atimers (1);
9977 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9978 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9979 fixup_locale ();
9980 #endif
9983 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9984 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9985 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9986 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9987 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9989 /* Detect failure. */
9990 if (dpy == 0)
9992 unblock_input ();
9993 return 0;
9996 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9998 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
9999 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10001 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10004 struct x_display_info *share;
10005 Lisp_Object tail;
10007 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10008 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10009 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10010 SSDATA (display_name)))
10011 break;
10012 if (share)
10013 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10014 else
10016 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10017 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10018 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10020 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10021 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10022 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10023 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10024 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10026 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10028 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10030 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10031 list of terminals. */
10032 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10033 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10034 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10035 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10037 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10038 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10039 unblock_input ();
10040 kset_system_key_alist
10041 (terminal->kboard,
10042 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10043 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10044 block_input ();
10045 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10046 terminal_list = terminal;
10047 UNGCPRO;
10050 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10051 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10052 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10053 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10054 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10056 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10059 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10060 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10061 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10063 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10064 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10065 x_display_name_list);
10066 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10068 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10070 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10071 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10072 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10073 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10075 #if 0
10076 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10077 #endif /* ! 0 */
10079 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10080 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10081 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10082 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10083 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10084 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10085 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10087 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10088 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10090 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10091 #ifdef USE_GTK
10092 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10093 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10094 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10096 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10097 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10099 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10100 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10101 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10102 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10103 #else
10104 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10105 #endif
10106 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10107 all versions. */
10108 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10110 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10111 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10112 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10113 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10114 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10115 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10116 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10117 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10118 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10119 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10120 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10121 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10122 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10123 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10124 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10125 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10126 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10127 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10128 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10129 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10130 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10131 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10132 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10133 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10134 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10135 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10136 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10138 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10139 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10140 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10142 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10144 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10145 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10146 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10147 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10148 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10149 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10152 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10153 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10155 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10157 Lisp_Object value;
10158 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10159 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10160 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10161 Qnil, Qnil);
10162 if (STRINGP (value)
10163 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10164 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10165 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10168 else
10169 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10170 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10172 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10174 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10175 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10176 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10177 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10178 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10179 for example). */
10180 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10181 double d;
10182 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10183 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10185 #endif
10187 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10189 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10190 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10191 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10192 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10193 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10194 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10195 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10196 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10197 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10201 const struct
10203 const char *name;
10204 Atom *atom;
10205 } atom_refs[] = {
10206 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10207 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10208 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10209 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10210 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10211 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10212 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10213 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10214 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10215 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10216 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10217 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10218 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10219 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10220 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10221 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10222 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10223 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10224 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10225 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10226 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10227 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10228 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10229 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10230 /* For properties of font. */
10231 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10232 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10233 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10234 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10235 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10236 /* Ghostscript support. */
10237 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10238 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10239 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10240 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10241 /* EWMH */
10242 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10243 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10244 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10245 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10246 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10247 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10248 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10249 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10250 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10251 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10252 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10253 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10254 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10255 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10256 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10257 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10258 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10259 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10260 /* Session management */
10261 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10262 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10263 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10266 int i;
10267 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10268 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10269 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10270 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10271 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10272 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10273 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10274 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10276 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10277 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10279 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10280 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10281 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10282 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10284 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10285 False, atoms_return);
10287 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10288 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10290 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10291 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10293 xfree (atom_names);
10294 xfree (atoms_return);
10297 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10298 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10299 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10300 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10302 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10303 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10304 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10306 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10307 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10308 dpyinfo->gray
10309 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10310 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10311 1, 0, 1);
10313 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10314 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10315 #endif
10317 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10319 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10320 if (connection != 0)
10321 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10323 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10324 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10325 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10327 if (interrupt_input)
10328 init_sigio (connection);
10330 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10332 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10333 Font font;
10335 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10336 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10337 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10338 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10339 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10340 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10341 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10342 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10343 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10344 emacs_abort ();
10345 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10346 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10347 x_uncatch_errors ();
10349 #endif
10351 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10352 for debugging X code. */
10354 Lisp_Object value;
10355 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10356 build_string ("synchronous"),
10357 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10358 Qnil, Qnil);
10359 if (STRINGP (value)
10360 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10361 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10362 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10366 Lisp_Object value;
10367 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10368 build_string ("useXIM"),
10369 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10370 Qnil, Qnil);
10371 #ifdef USE_XIM
10372 if (STRINGP (value)
10373 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10374 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10375 use_xim = 0;
10376 #else
10377 if (STRINGP (value)
10378 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10379 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10380 use_xim = 1;
10381 #endif
10384 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10385 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10386 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10387 tty. */
10388 if (terminal->id == 1)
10389 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10390 #endif
10392 unblock_input ();
10394 return dpyinfo;
10397 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10398 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10400 static void
10401 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10403 struct terminal *t;
10405 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10406 X display. */
10407 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10408 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10410 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10411 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10412 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10413 x_session_close ();
10414 #endif
10415 delete_terminal (t);
10416 break;
10419 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10421 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10422 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10423 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10424 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10425 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10426 else
10428 Lisp_Object tail;
10430 tail = x_display_name_list;
10431 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10433 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10435 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10436 break;
10438 tail = XCDR (tail);
10442 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10443 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10445 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10446 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10447 else
10449 struct x_display_info *tail;
10451 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10452 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10453 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10456 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10457 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10458 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10459 xfree (dpyinfo);
10462 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10464 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10465 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10466 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10467 that slows us down. */
10469 static void
10470 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10472 block_input ();
10473 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10474 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10476 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10477 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10478 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10479 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10481 unblock_input ();
10484 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10485 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10486 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10487 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10488 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10489 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10490 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10492 void
10493 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10495 block_input ();
10496 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10498 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10499 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10500 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10502 unblock_input ();
10505 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10508 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10510 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10512 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10513 x_produce_glyphs,
10514 x_write_glyphs,
10515 x_insert_glyphs,
10516 x_clear_end_of_line,
10517 x_scroll_run,
10518 x_after_update_window_line,
10519 x_update_window_begin,
10520 x_update_window_end,
10521 x_cursor_to,
10522 x_flush,
10523 #ifdef XFlush
10524 x_flush,
10525 #else
10526 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10527 #endif
10528 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10529 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10530 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10531 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10532 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10533 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10534 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10535 x_draw_glyph_string,
10536 x_define_frame_cursor,
10537 x_clear_frame_area,
10538 x_draw_window_cursor,
10539 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10540 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10544 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10545 void
10546 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10548 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10550 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10551 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10552 if (!terminal->name)
10553 return;
10555 block_input ();
10556 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10557 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10558 X display. */
10559 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10560 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10561 #endif
10563 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10564 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10565 if (dpyinfo->display)
10567 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10568 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10570 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10571 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10572 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10573 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10575 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10576 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10577 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10578 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10579 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10580 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10581 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10582 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10583 leaks in other situations. */
10584 #if 0
10585 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10586 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10587 #else
10588 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10589 #endif
10590 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10591 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10592 closing all the displays. */
10593 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10594 #endif
10596 #ifdef USE_GTK
10597 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10598 #else
10599 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10600 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10601 #else
10602 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10603 #endif
10604 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10607 /* Mark as dead. */
10608 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10609 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10610 unblock_input ();
10613 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10614 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10616 static struct terminal *
10617 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10619 struct terminal *terminal;
10621 terminal = create_terminal ();
10623 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10624 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10625 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10627 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10629 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10630 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10631 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10632 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10633 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10634 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10635 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10636 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10637 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10638 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10639 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10640 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10641 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10642 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10643 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10644 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10645 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10646 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10647 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10648 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10650 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10651 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10653 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10654 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10655 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10656 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10657 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10658 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10659 off the bottom. */
10661 return terminal;
10664 void
10665 x_initialize (void)
10667 baud_rate = 19200;
10669 x_noop_count = 0;
10670 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10671 any_help_event_p = 0;
10672 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10674 #ifdef USE_GTK
10675 current_count = -1;
10676 #endif
10678 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10679 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10681 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10682 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10684 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10686 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10687 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10688 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10689 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10690 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10691 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10692 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10694 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10695 #endif
10697 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10698 #ifndef USE_GTK
10699 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10700 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10701 #endif
10702 #endif
10704 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10705 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10706 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10708 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10709 original error handler. */
10710 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10711 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10715 void
10716 syms_of_xterm (void)
10718 x_error_message = NULL;
10720 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10721 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10723 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10724 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10726 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10727 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10729 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10730 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10732 #ifdef USE_GTK
10733 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10734 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10736 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10737 #endif
10739 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10740 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10741 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10742 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10743 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10744 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10745 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10746 sizes. */);
10747 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10749 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10750 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10751 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10752 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10753 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10754 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10755 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10757 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10758 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10759 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10760 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10761 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10762 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10763 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10764 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10765 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10767 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10768 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10769 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10770 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10771 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10772 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10774 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10775 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10776 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10777 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10778 #elif USE_GTK
10779 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10780 #else
10781 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10782 #endif
10783 #else
10784 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10785 #endif
10787 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10788 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10790 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10791 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10792 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10793 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10794 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10795 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10796 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10797 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10798 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10800 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10801 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10802 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10803 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10804 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10805 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10807 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10808 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10809 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10810 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10811 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10812 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10814 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10815 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10816 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10817 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10818 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10819 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10821 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10822 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10823 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10824 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10825 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10826 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10828 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10829 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10830 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10831 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10832 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10833 Qnil);
10836 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */